<?xml version="1.0"?>
<feed xmlns="http://www.w3.org/2005/Atom" xml:lang="de-formal">
	<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/api.php?action=feedcontributions&amp;feedformat=atom&amp;user=Mschindler</id>
	<title>Maxcrc MediaWiki - Benutzerbeiträge [de-formal]</title>
	<link rel="self" type="application/atom+xml" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/api.php?action=feedcontributions&amp;feedformat=atom&amp;user=Mschindler"/>
	<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/wiki/Spezial:Beitr%C3%A4ge/Mschindler"/>
	<updated>2026-05-11T18:56:53Z</updated>
	<subtitle>Benutzerbeiträge</subtitle>
	<generator>MediaWiki 1.31.1</generator>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5890</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5890"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T15:07:25Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Edit existing Location */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Under [[#Location| Location]] Under Location, click the location you want to edit&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Here you can see an overview of all positions and their assigned locations&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Events===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, the events of all access controls are shown in an intuitive list view. There are filtering options and a name search for the events.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The following filters can be set:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Location&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Factory&lt;br /&gt;
#Search by Event name&lt;br /&gt;
#Time Period&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definitions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all events that the FMCU contains are listed and their event definition groups, supported states and categories are assigned.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definition groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
All event definition groups are listed under this tab.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Create a new event definition group====&lt;br /&gt;
Click [[#Event defenition groups|Event defenition groups]] on the Button '''New'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Fieldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatically generated unique group number&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Group description&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Absolutely required fields&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Under the '''Event defenition''' tab select the event definitions that are to be assigned to the group.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event subscriptions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
There is the possibility to link groups of alarm messages with groups of users. As a result, only group members are notified of alarm messages that are also grouped, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Fieldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|ID&lt;br /&gt;
|internal value&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|Summary of users&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Notifications deactivated/activated&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Notifications===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/notifications&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Sent notifications are displayed in this overview. You can adjust the view accordingly using a date filter.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image notofication statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Cards==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
This view shows an overview of the RFID cards in the system with the gates enabled for access.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card overview.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Edit Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards-edit&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, cards can be added / removed and authorizations for individual gates can be defined.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card settings.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Field&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Barcode&lt;br /&gt;
|Card content that is captured by the reader&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Quantity&lt;br /&gt;
|Number of accesses for this card&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Statistics==&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all activities for the assigned access controls are shown. You can adjust the view with date filters. It is possible to group the screen output, e.g. only to evaluate the number per day or month. Finally, the data can be exported in Excel format or CSV-format.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Kategorie:Galaxy Gate]]&lt;br /&gt;
{{DEFAULTSORT:Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5888</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5888"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T14:51:04Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Here you can see an overview of all positions and their assigned locations&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Events===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, the events of all access controls are shown in an intuitive list view. There are filtering options and a name search for the events.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The following filters can be set:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Location&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Factory&lt;br /&gt;
#Search by Event name&lt;br /&gt;
#Time Period&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definitions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all events that the FMCU contains are listed and their event definition groups, supported states and categories are assigned.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definition groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
All event definition groups are listed under this tab.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Create a new event definition group====&lt;br /&gt;
Click [[#Event defenition groups|Event defenition groups]] on the Button '''New'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Fieldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatically generated unique group number&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Group description&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Absolutely required fields&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Under the '''Event defenition''' tab select the event definitions that are to be assigned to the group.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event subscriptions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
There is the possibility to link groups of alarm messages with groups of users. As a result, only group members are notified of alarm messages that are also grouped, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Fieldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|ID&lt;br /&gt;
|internal value&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|Summary of users&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Notifications deactivated/activated&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Notifications===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/notifications&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Sent notifications are displayed in this overview. You can adjust the view accordingly using a date filter.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image notofication statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Cards==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
This view shows an overview of the RFID cards in the system with the gates enabled for access.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card overview.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Edit Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards-edit&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, cards can be added / removed and authorizations for individual gates can be defined.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card settings.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Field&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Barcode&lt;br /&gt;
|Card content that is captured by the reader&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Quantity&lt;br /&gt;
|Number of accesses for this card&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Statistics==&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all activities for the assigned access controls are shown. You can adjust the view with date filters. It is possible to group the screen output, e.g. only to evaluate the number per day or month. Finally, the data can be exported in Excel format or CSV-format.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Kategorie:Galaxy Gate]]&lt;br /&gt;
{{DEFAULTSORT:Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5886</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5886"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T13:55:28Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Create a new event definition group */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Events===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definitions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definition groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Create a new event definition group====&lt;br /&gt;
Click [[#Event defenition groups|Event defenition groups]] on the Button '''New'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Fieldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatically generated unique group number&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Group description&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Absolutely required fields&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Under the '''Event defenition''' tab select the event definitions that are to be assigned to the group.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event subscriptions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
There is the possibility to link groups of alarm messages with groups of users. As a result, only group members are notified of alarm messages that are also grouped, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Fieldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|ID&lt;br /&gt;
|internal value&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|Summary of users&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Notifications deactivated/activated&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Notifications===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/notifications&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Sent notifications are displayed in this overview. You can adjust the view accordingly using a date filter.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image notofication statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Cards==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
This view shows an overview of the RFID cards in the system with the gates enabled for access.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card overview.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Edit Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards-edit&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, cards can be added / removed and authorizations for individual gates can be defined.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card settings.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Field&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Barcode&lt;br /&gt;
|Card content that is captured by the reader&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Quantity&lt;br /&gt;
|Number of accesses for this card&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Statistics==&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all activities for the assigned access controls are shown. You can adjust the view with date filters. It is possible to group the screen output, e.g. only to evaluate the number per day or month. Finally, the data can be exported in Excel format or CSV-format.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Kategorie:Galaxy Gate]]&lt;br /&gt;
{{DEFAULTSORT:Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5884</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5884"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T13:47:13Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Event subscriptions */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Events===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definitions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definition groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Create a new event definition group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event subscriptions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
There is the possibility to link groups of alarm messages with groups of users. As a result, only group members are notified of alarm messages that are also grouped, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Fieldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|ID&lt;br /&gt;
|internal value&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|Summary of users&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Notifications deactivated/activated&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Notifications===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/notifications&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Sent notifications are displayed in this overview. You can adjust the view accordingly using a date filter.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image notofication statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Cards==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
This view shows an overview of the RFID cards in the system with the gates enabled for access.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card overview.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Edit Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards-edit&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, cards can be added / removed and authorizations for individual gates can be defined.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card settings.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Field&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Barcode&lt;br /&gt;
|Card content that is captured by the reader&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Quantity&lt;br /&gt;
|Number of accesses for this card&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Statistics==&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all activities for the assigned access controls are shown. You can adjust the view with date filters. It is possible to group the screen output, e.g. only to evaluate the number per day or month. Finally, the data can be exported in Excel format or CSV-format.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Kategorie:Galaxy Gate]]&lt;br /&gt;
{{DEFAULTSORT:Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5882</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5882"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T13:43:07Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Edit Cards */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Events===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definitions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definition groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Create a new event definition group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event subscriptions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Es gibt hier die Möglichkeit, Gruppen von Alarmmeldungen mit Gruppen von Benutzern zu verbinden. Im Ergebnis werden nur Gruppenmitglieder über ebenfalls gruppierte Alarmmeldungen benachrichtigt, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|id&lt;br /&gt;
|interner Wert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Benutzern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Alarmmeldungen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Benachrichtigung deaktiviert/aktiviert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Notifications===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/notifications&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Sent notifications are displayed in this overview. You can adjust the view accordingly using a date filter.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image notofication statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Cards==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
This view shows an overview of the RFID cards in the system with the gates enabled for access.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card overview.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Edit Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards-edit&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, cards can be added / removed and authorizations for individual gates can be defined.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card settings.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Field&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Barcode&lt;br /&gt;
|Card content that is captured by the reader&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Quantity&lt;br /&gt;
|Number of accesses for this card&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Statistics==&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all activities for the assigned access controls are shown. You can adjust the view with date filters. It is possible to group the screen output, e.g. only to evaluate the number per day or month. Finally, the data can be exported in Excel format or CSV-format.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Kategorie:Galaxy Gate]]&lt;br /&gt;
{{DEFAULTSORT:Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5880</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5880"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T13:38:13Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Edit Cards */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Events===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definitions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definition groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Create a new event definition group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event subscriptions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Es gibt hier die Möglichkeit, Gruppen von Alarmmeldungen mit Gruppen von Benutzern zu verbinden. Im Ergebnis werden nur Gruppenmitglieder über ebenfalls gruppierte Alarmmeldungen benachrichtigt, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|id&lt;br /&gt;
|interner Wert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Benutzern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Alarmmeldungen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Benachrichtigung deaktiviert/aktiviert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Notifications===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/notifications&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Übersicht werden versendete Benachrichtigungen angezeigt. Man kann über Datumsfilter die Ansicht entsprechend anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image notofication statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Cards==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht wird eine Übersicht der im System vorhandenen RFID-Karten mit den für den Zutritt freigeschalteten Gates  angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card overview.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Edit Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards-edit&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht können Karten hinzugefügt/entfernt und Berechtigungen für einzelne Gates definiert werden.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card settings.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Field&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Barcode&lt;br /&gt;
|Card content that is captured by the reader&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Employee ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Description field&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Quantity&lt;br /&gt;
|Number of accesses for this card&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Statistics==&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all activities for the assigned access controls are shown. You can adjust the view with date filters. It is possible to group the screen output, e.g. only to evaluate the number per day or month. Finally, the data can be exported in Excel format or CSV-format.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Kategorie:Galaxy Gate]]&lt;br /&gt;
{{DEFAULTSORT:Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5878</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5878"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T13:35:39Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Events===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definitions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event definition groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Create a new event definition group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Event subscriptions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Es gibt hier die Möglichkeit, Gruppen von Alarmmeldungen mit Gruppen von Benutzern zu verbinden. Im Ergebnis werden nur Gruppenmitglieder über ebenfalls gruppierte Alarmmeldungen benachrichtigt, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|id&lt;br /&gt;
|interner Wert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Benutzern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Alarmmeldungen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Benachrichtigung deaktiviert/aktiviert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Notifications===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/notifications&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Übersicht werden versendete Benachrichtigungen angezeigt. Man kann über Datumsfilter die Ansicht entsprechend anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image notofication statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Cards==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht wird eine Übersicht der im System vorhandenen RFID-Karten mit den für den Zutritt freigeschalteten Gates  angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card overview.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Edit Cards===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards-edit&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht können Karten hinzugefügt/entfernt und Berechtigungen für einzelne Gates definiert werden.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card settings.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Feld&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Barcode&lt;br /&gt;
|Karteninhalt, der vom Leser erfasst wird&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Mitarbeiter&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Mitarbeiter ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Anzahl&lt;br /&gt;
|Anzahl der Zutritte für diese Karte&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Statistics==&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all activities for the assigned access controls are shown. You can adjust the view with date filters. It is possible to group the screen output, e.g. only to evaluate the number per day or month. Finally, the data can be exported in Excel format or CSV-format.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Kategorie:Galaxy Gate]]&lt;br /&gt;
{{DEFAULTSORT:Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5876</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5876"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:33:26Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Statistics */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Es gibt hier die Möglichkeit, Gruppen von Alarmmeldungen mit Gruppen von Benutzern zu verbinden. Im Ergebnis werden nur Gruppenmitglieder über ebenfalls gruppierte Alarmmeldungen benachrichtigt, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|id&lt;br /&gt;
|interner Wert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Benutzern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Alarmmeldungen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Benachrichtigung deaktiviert/aktiviert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/notifications&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Übersicht werden versendete Benachrichtigungen angezeigt. Man kann über Datumsfilter die Ansicht entsprechend anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image notofication statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht wird eine Übersicht der im System vorhandenen RFID-Karten mit den für den Zutritt freigeschalteten Gates  angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card overview.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards-edit&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht können Karten hinzugefügt/entfernt und Berechtigungen für einzelne Gates definiert werden.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card settings.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Feld&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Barcode&lt;br /&gt;
|Karteninhalt, der vom Leser erfasst wird&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Mitarbeiter&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Mitarbeiter ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Anzahl&lt;br /&gt;
|Anzahl der Zutritte für diese Karte&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Aktivitäten zu den zugeordneten Zutrittskontrollen dargestellt. Man kann mit Datumsfiltern die Ansicht anpassen. Es gibt die Möglich die Bildschirmausgabe zu gruppieren, um z.B. nur die Anzahl pro Tag oder Monat auszuwerten. Schließlich kann man die Daten im Excel-Format oder CSV-Format exportieren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Kategorie:Galaxy Gate]]&lt;br /&gt;
{{DEFAULTSORT:Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5874</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5874"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:32:45Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Edit Cards */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Es gibt hier die Möglichkeit, Gruppen von Alarmmeldungen mit Gruppen von Benutzern zu verbinden. Im Ergebnis werden nur Gruppenmitglieder über ebenfalls gruppierte Alarmmeldungen benachrichtigt, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|id&lt;br /&gt;
|interner Wert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Benutzern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Alarmmeldungen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Benachrichtigung deaktiviert/aktiviert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/notifications&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Übersicht werden versendete Benachrichtigungen angezeigt. Man kann über Datumsfilter die Ansicht entsprechend anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image notofication statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht wird eine Übersicht der im System vorhandenen RFID-Karten mit den für den Zutritt freigeschalteten Gates  angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card overview.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards-edit&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht können Karten hinzugefügt/entfernt und Berechtigungen für einzelne Gates definiert werden.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card settings.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Feld&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Barcode&lt;br /&gt;
|Karteninhalt, der vom Leser erfasst wird&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Mitarbeiter&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Mitarbeiter ID&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Anzahl&lt;br /&gt;
|Anzahl der Zutritte für diese Karte&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5872</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5872"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:32:03Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Cards */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Es gibt hier die Möglichkeit, Gruppen von Alarmmeldungen mit Gruppen von Benutzern zu verbinden. Im Ergebnis werden nur Gruppenmitglieder über ebenfalls gruppierte Alarmmeldungen benachrichtigt, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|id&lt;br /&gt;
|interner Wert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Benutzern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Alarmmeldungen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Benachrichtigung deaktiviert/aktiviert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/notifications&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Übersicht werden versendete Benachrichtigungen angezeigt. Man kann über Datumsfilter die Ansicht entsprechend anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image notofication statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cards&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht wird eine Übersicht der im System vorhandenen RFID-Karten mit den für den Zutritt freigeschalteten Gates  angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image card overview.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5870</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5870"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:31:37Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Notifications */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Es gibt hier die Möglichkeit, Gruppen von Alarmmeldungen mit Gruppen von Benutzern zu verbinden. Im Ergebnis werden nur Gruppenmitglieder über ebenfalls gruppierte Alarmmeldungen benachrichtigt, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|id&lt;br /&gt;
|interner Wert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Benutzern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Alarmmeldungen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Benachrichtigung deaktiviert/aktiviert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/notifications&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Übersicht werden versendete Benachrichtigungen angezeigt. Man kann über Datumsfilter die Ansicht entsprechend anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image notofication statistics.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5868</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5868"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:30:43Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Event subscriptions */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Es gibt hier die Möglichkeit, Gruppen von Alarmmeldungen mit Gruppen von Benutzern zu verbinden. Im Ergebnis werden nur Gruppenmitglieder über ebenfalls gruppierte Alarmmeldungen benachrichtigt, &lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image event subscription.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
|+&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|id&lt;br /&gt;
|interner Wert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Benutzern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|Zusammenfassung von Alarmmeldungen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Benachrichtigung deaktiviert/aktiviert&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibungsfeld&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5866</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5866"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:30:03Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Create a new event definition group */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5864</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5864"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:29:33Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5862</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5862"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:29:05Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Event definition groups */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Neue Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe anlegen===&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5860</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5860"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:28:15Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
===Neue Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe anlegen===&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5858</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5858"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:27:48Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Event definitions */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Ereignisse welche die FMCU beinhaltet aufgelistet und deren Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen, Unterstütze Zustände und Kategorie zugeordnet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definitions.png|rahmenlos|1037x1037px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Neue Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe anlegen===&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
===Neue Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe anlegen===&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5856</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5856"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:26:31Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Event definition groups */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
===Neue Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe anlegen===&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
===Neue Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe anlegen===&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5854</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5854"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:24:31Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Event definitions */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden alle Ereignsidefinitionsgruppen aufgelistet.[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard event-definition-groups.png|rahmenlos|1038x1038px]]&lt;br /&gt;
===Neue Ereignisdefinitionsgruppe anlegen===&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen|Ereignisdefinitionsgruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new event-definition-group.png|rahmenlos|1048x1048px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie unter dem Reiter '''Ereignisdefinitionen''' die Ereignisdefinitionen aus welche der Gruppe zugeornet werden sollen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5852</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5852"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:23:22Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Events */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/events&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden die Ereignisse aller Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Listenansicht dargestellt. Es existieren Filterungsmöglichkeiten und eine Namenssuche der Ereignisse.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Events.png|rahmenlos|1050x1050px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es können folgende Filter gesetzt werden:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Standort&lt;br /&gt;
#Position&lt;br /&gt;
#Anlage&lt;br /&gt;
#Suche nach Ereignisnamen&lt;br /&gt;
#Zeitraum&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5850</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5850"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T10:22:58Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Events ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Events ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definitions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event definition groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Create a new event definition group ====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Event subscriptions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Notifications ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Cards ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit Cards ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Statistics ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5848</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5848"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T09:55:27Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Configuration */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/configurations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5846</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5846"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T09:53:39Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Locations &amp;amp; Positions */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/locations&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen und deren zugeordnete Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5844</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5844"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T09:48:54Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Locations */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/countries&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Standorte&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-country&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standorte | Standorte]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name*&lt;br /&gt;
|Name des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Code*&lt;br /&gt;
|Ländercode des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Standorts&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Standort| Standort]] auf die zu bearbeitende Standort&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Hier können Sie die den Namen, den Code sowie die Info des Standorts bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5842</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5842"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T09:45:36Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Positions */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/cities&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Positionen&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-city&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen | Positionen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
Geben Sie den Namen der Postition ein und ordnen Sie die Position mit dem Dropdown Feld einem Standort zu.&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf den Button '''Speichern''' umd die Position anzulegen&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Positionen| Positionen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Position&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie die den Namen und den Standort der Position bearbeiten&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5840</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5840"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T09:43:43Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Administration==&lt;br /&gt;
===User===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/users&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard_Users.png|rahmenlos|1241x1241px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Neuen Benutzer anlegen&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Standort filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzer nach Postition filtern&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new User====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer| Benutzer]] auf den Button '''Neu'''&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-user&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new Users.png|rahmenlos|1139x1139px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername*&lt;br /&gt;
|Benutzername des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort*&lt;br /&gt;
|Passwort des Benutzers für die Anmeldung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Email&lt;br /&gt;
|Email Adresse des Benutzers zum Versand von Log Nachrichten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname&lt;br /&gt;
|Vorname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname&lt;br /&gt;
|Nachname des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Superuser&lt;br /&gt;
|Die höchsten Rechte werden dem Benutzer vergeben&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|Die Anmeldung des Benutzers ist gesperrt&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Meldungen deaktivieren&lt;br /&gt;
|Der Benutzer erhält keine Benachritgungen im FMCU Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird der neue Benutzer angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing user====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Benutzer | Benutzer]] auf den zu bearbeitenden Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
=====Event notifications=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können die Benachrichtigungen ausgewählt werden welcher der Benutzer erhalten soll.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;'''Hinweis:''' Ist die Checkbox '''Meldungen deaktivieren''' gesetzt werden unabhängig von diesen Einstellungen keine Benachrichtigungen angezeigt.&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Man kann unterschiedliche Standorte in Länder und Städte festlegen. Über das Berechtigungsmodell lassen sich separate Zugriffsrechte für jeden Standort definieren.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Groups tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Gruppenmitgliedschaften des Benutzers anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen des Benutzers angezeigt&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Groups===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/groups&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Auf dieser Seite sehen Sie eine Übersicht aller Gruppen[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard groups.png|rahmenlos|1133x1133px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new group====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/new-group&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf den Button '''Neu'''[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard new groups.png|rahmenlos|1134x1134px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Feldname&lt;br /&gt;
!Beschreibung&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Id&lt;br /&gt;
|Automatisch generierte eindeutige Nummer der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Beschreibung der Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
'''*''' Unbedingt erforderliche Felder&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Durch den Button '''Speichern''' wird die neue Gruppe angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing group====&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie unter [[#Gruppen | Gruppen]] auf die zu bearbeitende Gruppe&lt;br /&gt;
=====Users tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter können Sie die Mitglieder der Gruppe anpassen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=====Permissions tab=====&lt;br /&gt;
Unter diesem Reiter werden die Berechtigungen angezeigt welche den Mitgliedern der Gruppe vererbt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;Durch den Button '''Speichern''' werden alle Änderungen angewendet.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Position====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up new Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Location====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Locations &amp;amp; Positions===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Configuration===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5838</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5838"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T07:13:54Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Administration ==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== User ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Set up new User ====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Edit existing user ====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===== Event notifications =====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===== Locations &amp;amp; Positions tab =====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===== Groups tab =====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===== Permissions tab =====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Groups ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Set up new group ====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Edit existing group ====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===== Users tab =====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===== Permissions tab =====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Positions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Set up new Position ====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Edit existing Position ====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Locations ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Set up new Location ====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==== Edit existing Location ====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Locations &amp;amp; Positions ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Configuration ===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5836</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5836"/>
		<updated>2022-01-13T06:47:47Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Number&lt;br /&gt;
!Function&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5834</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5834"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T15:02:02Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Menu items==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, all access controls are shown in an intuitive interface. There are grouping options in two categories. First of all, you can group by '''location'''. You can then combine different '''positions''' within the location. Individual gates can be added using the &amp;quot;'''New'''&amp;quot; menu item. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In this view you create a '''new''' gate. The fields '''names''', '''displayed''' '''name''' and '''Position''' of the Gate must be verified with values. Then click on Attachments.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]]You can now see in the view that you have created a '''NEW''' gate,&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
in this case the fourth gate in this view.[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step you connect the gate to the server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;To do this, check on the '''General''' tab that the correct gate name has been entered.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Then check the following points on the '''Server''' tab.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- must be set to remote.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Activated slide-switch is activated.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your server should be entered under Name*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your URL should be entered under URL*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gate should be entered under Username*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Your password should be entered under Password*.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Save''' at the end. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the next step, please click on System in the top bar.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You will now see the following display, here please press restart once. Now your new gate should be connected.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Finally, you can check the connection in the '''Status''' tab. '''CONNECTED''' must now appear under State.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to edit (in the example P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Edit&amp;quot; function.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
You can now edit the gate in this view.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
You are in the same view as where you would create a new gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Please move the slide switch &amp;quot;Grid view&amp;quot; to the left.[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In the view click on the name of the gate which you want to delete (in the example P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In this view, please press the &amp;quot;Delete&amp;quot; function. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
To be on the safe side, you will now be asked again whether you really want to delete the element? Please confirm this. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
After deleting, you will automatically be shown the next gate (here in the example P1_TestGate2). Please click on attachments here. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
You will then see in the grid view that Gate P1_TestGate6 is missing and has been successfully deleted. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5832</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5832"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:45:28Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Menu items ==&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Oberfläche dargestellt. Es existieren Gruppierungsmöglichkeiten in zwei Kategorien. Zunächst kann man nach '''Standort''' gruppieren. Innerhalb des Standortes kann man dann verschiedene '''Lokationen''' zusammenfassen.  &lt;br /&gt;
Einzelne Gates können über den Menüpunkt &amp;quot;'''Neu'''&amp;quot; hinzugefügt werden. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht legen Sie ein '''neues''' Gate an. Die Felder '''Namen''', '''Anzeigename''' und '''Position''' des Gates müssen mit Werten belegt werden. Danach auf Anlagen klicken.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]] &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun in der Ansicht das Sie ein '''NEUES''' Gate angelegt haben,  &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
in diesem Fall das vierte Gate in dieser Ansicht. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt verbinden Sie das Gate mit dem Server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;Prüfen Sie hierzu auf dem Reiter '''Allgemein''' das der korrekte Gate-Name eingetragen ist.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfen Sie dann auf dem Reiter '''Server''' folgende Punkte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- muss auf Fern eingestellt sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schiebeschalter Aktiviert ist aktiviert.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Name* sollte ihr Server eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter URL* sollte ihre URL eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Benutzername* sollte gate eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Passwort* sollte ihr Passwort eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Am Ende '''Speichern.''' &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt bitte in der oberen Leiste auf  System klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen jetzt folgende Darstellung, hier bitte einmal auf Neustart drücken.&lt;br /&gt;
Jetzt sollte Ihr neues Gate verbunden sein.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können abschließend im Reiter '''Status''' noch die Verbindung prüfen. Unter Zustand muss jetzt '''VERBUNDEN''' erscheinen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;Sie befinden sich in der gleichen Ansicht wo Sie auch ein neues Gate anlegen würden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Verschieben Sie hier bitte den Schiebeschalter &amp;quot;Rasteransicht&amp;quot; nach links.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der Ansicht klicken Sie auf den Namen des Gates welches Sie bearbeiten möchten (im Beispiel P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht bitte die Funktion &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot; drücken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht können Sie nun das Gate bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;Sie befinden sich in der gleichen Ansicht wo Sie auch ein neues Gate anlegen würden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Verschieben Sie hier bitte den Schiebeschalter &amp;quot;Rasteransicht&amp;quot; nach links.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In der Ansicht klicken Sie auf den Namen des Gates welches Sie löschen möchten (im Beispiel P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht bitte die Funktion &amp;quot;Löschen&amp;quot; drücken. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Es wird nun zur Sicherheit nochmal abgefragt ob Sie das Element wirklich löschen möchten? &lt;br /&gt;
Bestätigen Sie dies bitte. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach dem Löschen schon automatisch das nächste Gate angezeigt (hier im Beispiel P1_TestGate2). &lt;br /&gt;
Hier bitte auf Anlagen drücken. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen dann in der Rasteransicht das, das Gate P1_TestGate6 fehlt und erfolgreich gelöscht wurde. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5830</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5830"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:44:50Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Gates===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Oberfläche dargestellt. Es existieren Gruppierungsmöglichkeiten in zwei Kategorien. Zunächst kann man nach '''Standort''' gruppieren. Innerhalb des Standortes kann man dann verschiedene '''Lokationen''' zusammenfassen.  &lt;br /&gt;
Einzelne Gates können über den Menüpunkt &amp;quot;'''Neu'''&amp;quot; hinzugefügt werden. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Set up a new Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht legen Sie ein '''neues''' Gate an. Die Felder '''Namen''', '''Anzeigename''' und '''Position''' des Gates müssen mit Werten belegt werden. Danach auf Anlagen klicken.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]] &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun in der Ansicht das Sie ein '''NEUES''' Gate angelegt haben,  &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
in diesem Fall das vierte Gate in dieser Ansicht. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt verbinden Sie das Gate mit dem Server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;Prüfen Sie hierzu auf dem Reiter '''Allgemein''' das der korrekte Gate-Name eingetragen ist.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfen Sie dann auf dem Reiter '''Server''' folgende Punkte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- muss auf Fern eingestellt sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schiebeschalter Aktiviert ist aktiviert.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Name* sollte ihr Server eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter URL* sollte ihre URL eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Benutzername* sollte gate eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Passwort* sollte ihr Passwort eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Am Ende '''Speichern.''' &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt bitte in der oberen Leiste auf  System klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen jetzt folgende Darstellung, hier bitte einmal auf Neustart drücken.&lt;br /&gt;
Jetzt sollte Ihr neues Gate verbunden sein.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können abschließend im Reiter '''Status''' noch die Verbindung prüfen. Unter Zustand muss jetzt '''VERBUNDEN''' erscheinen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Edit existing Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;Sie befinden sich in der gleichen Ansicht wo Sie auch ein neues Gate anlegen würden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Verschieben Sie hier bitte den Schiebeschalter &amp;quot;Rasteransicht&amp;quot; nach links.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der Ansicht klicken Sie auf den Namen des Gates welches Sie bearbeiten möchten (im Beispiel P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht bitte die Funktion &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot; drücken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht können Sie nun das Gate bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Remove Gate====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;Sie befinden sich in der gleichen Ansicht wo Sie auch ein neues Gate anlegen würden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Verschieben Sie hier bitte den Schiebeschalter &amp;quot;Rasteransicht&amp;quot; nach links.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In der Ansicht klicken Sie auf den Namen des Gates welches Sie löschen möchten (im Beispiel P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht bitte die Funktion &amp;quot;Löschen&amp;quot; drücken. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Es wird nun zur Sicherheit nochmal abgefragt ob Sie das Element wirklich löschen möchten? &lt;br /&gt;
Bestätigen Sie dies bitte. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach dem Löschen schon automatisch das nächste Gate angezeigt (hier im Beispiel P1_TestGate2). &lt;br /&gt;
Hier bitte auf Anlagen drücken. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen dann in der Rasteransicht das, das Gate P1_TestGate6 fehlt und erfolgreich gelöscht wurde. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5828</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5828"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:43:25Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Gates */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Gates==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht werden alle Zutrittskontrollen in einer intuitiven Oberfläche dargestellt. Es existieren Gruppierungsmöglichkeiten in zwei Kategorien. Zunächst kann man nach '''Standort''' gruppieren. Innerhalb des Standortes kann man dann verschiedene '''Lokationen''' zusammenfassen.  &lt;br /&gt;
Einzelne Gates können über den Menüpunkt &amp;quot;'''Neu'''&amp;quot; hinzugefügt werden. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Set up a new Gate===&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht legen Sie ein '''neues''' Gate an. Die Felder '''Namen''', '''Anzeigename''' und '''Position''' des Gates müssen mit Werten belegt werden. Danach auf Anlagen klicken.[[Datei:FMCU3.png|ohne|mini|304x304px]] &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun in der Ansicht das Sie ein '''NEUES''' Gate angelegt haben,  &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
in diesem Fall das vierte Gate in dieser Ansicht. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU4.png|ohne|mini|299x299px]]        &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt verbinden Sie das Gate mit dem Server.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;IP-Adresse des Dashboards&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;Prüfen Sie hierzu auf dem Reiter '''Allgemein''' das der korrekte Gate-Name eingetragen ist.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfen Sie dann auf dem Reiter '''Server''' folgende Punkte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Server#0 (server)- muss auf Fern eingestellt sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schiebeschalter Aktiviert ist aktiviert.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Name* sollte ihr Server eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter URL* sollte ihre URL eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Benutzername* sollte gate eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Passwort* sollte ihr Passwort eingetragen sein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Am Ende '''Speichern.''' &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU7.png|ohne|mini|295x295px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt bitte in der oberen Leiste auf  System klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen jetzt folgende Darstellung, hier bitte einmal auf Neustart drücken.&lt;br /&gt;
Jetzt sollte Ihr neues Gate verbunden sein.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können abschließend im Reiter '''Status''' noch die Verbindung prüfen. Unter Zustand muss jetzt '''VERBUNDEN''' erscheinen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU11.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit existing Gate ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;Sie befinden sich in der gleichen Ansicht wo Sie auch ein neues Gate anlegen würden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Verschieben Sie hier bitte den Schiebeschalter &amp;quot;Rasteransicht&amp;quot; nach links.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der Ansicht klicken Sie auf den Namen des Gates welches Sie bearbeiten möchten (im Beispiel P1_TestGate2).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht bitte die Funktion &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot; drücken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht können Sie nun das Gate bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Remove Gate===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
https://&amp;lt;dns-name or ip-address&amp;gt;/gates&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;/syntaxhighlight&amp;gt;Sie befinden sich in der gleichen Ansicht wo Sie auch ein neues Gate anlegen würden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Verschieben Sie hier bitte den Schiebeschalter &amp;quot;Rasteransicht&amp;quot; nach links.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU12.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In der Ansicht klicken Sie auf den Namen des Gates welches Sie löschen möchten (im Beispiel P1_TestGate6). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU13.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
In dieser Ansicht bitte die Funktion &amp;quot;Löschen&amp;quot; drücken. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU14.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Es wird nun zur Sicherheit nochmal abgefragt ob Sie das Element wirklich löschen möchten? &lt;br /&gt;
Bestätigen Sie dies bitte. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU15.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach dem Löschen schon automatisch das nächste Gate angezeigt (hier im Beispiel P1_TestGate2). &lt;br /&gt;
Hier bitte auf Anlagen drücken. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU16.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen dann in der Rasteransicht das, das Gate P1_TestGate6 fehlt und erfolgreich gelöscht wurde. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:FMCU17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5826</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5826"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:39:38Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==   Gates ==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Set up a new Gate ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Edit existing Gate ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
=== Remove Gate ===&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5824</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5824"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:32:40Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Logged in User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Log out Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Languages menu&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5822</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5822"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:30:58Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Headline==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Registered Users display&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Button to log out the User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Menu to select the language&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5820</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5820"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:24:23Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Headline */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Headline ==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Cards&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Statistics Button&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Display from registered Users&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Button to log out the User&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Menu for selecting the language&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Adjust the display to the entire width of the screen&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5818</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5818"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:10:06Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Headline */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Headline ==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Ereignisse&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Karten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Statistiken&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Anzeige Angemeldeter Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Button zur Abmeldung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü zur Wahl der Anzeigesprache&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Anpassung der Darstellung auf die gesamte Bildschrimbreite&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5816</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5816"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:09:07Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Headline ==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Ereignisse&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Karten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Statistiken&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Anzeige Angemeldeter Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Button zur Abmeldung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü zur Wahl der Anzeigesprache&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Anpassung der Darstellung auf die gesamte Bildschrimbreite&lt;br /&gt;
|}|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5814</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5814"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:08:03Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Headline ==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Ereignisse&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Karten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Statistiken&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Anzeige Angemeldeter Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Button zur Abmeldung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü zur Wahl der Anzeigesprache&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Anpassung der Darstellung auf die gesamte Bildschrimbreite&lt;br /&gt;
|}|1&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5812</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5812"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:05:55Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Headline ==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
!Nummer&lt;br /&gt;
!Funktion&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|1&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Management Dashboard&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|2&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Administration&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|3&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Ereignisse&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|4&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü Karten&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|5&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Statistiken&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|6&lt;br /&gt;
|Anzeige Angemeldeter Benutzer&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|7&lt;br /&gt;
|Button zur Abmeldung des Benutzers&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|8&lt;br /&gt;
|Aufklappmenü zur Wahl der Anzeigesprache&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|9&lt;br /&gt;
|Button Anpassung der Darstellung auf die gesamte Bildschrimbreite&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5810</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5810"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:04:23Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Headline ==&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard Headline.png|links|rahmenlos|1000x1000px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5808</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5808"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T13:03:58Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==General==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== Headline ==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5806</id>
		<title>Gate ~ FMCU ~ management dashboard/en</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Gate_~_FMCU_~_management_dashboard/en&amp;diff=5806"/>
		<updated>2022-01-12T12:59:05Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;{{translate|Gate ~ FMCU Galaxy Gate ~ management dashboard}}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
== General ==&lt;br /&gt;
The Wanzl Access Manager offers a central dashbaord for access controls in a homogeneous interface, displays the corresponding states and supports the user in the administration of these components. The Wanzl Access Manager is a leading platform for monitoring and managing access controls of security areas.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
==Connectivity Board==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Contact&lt;br /&gt;
!Type&lt;br /&gt;
!Impulse&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Person has entered&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''A9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Output&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Alarms*&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E3'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E4'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Exit&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E6'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is valid, open the gate&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E7'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (200ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Card is invalid, do not open the gate  &lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E8'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Emergency State button**&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E9'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|Yes (500 ms)&lt;br /&gt;
|Open Entry 70%&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''E10'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Input&lt;br /&gt;
|No&lt;br /&gt;
|Fire Alarm&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;*&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;A9 Alarms:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is out of order, when a mandatory device is broken or a connection to the server is broken (if the server is used in the solution).&lt;br /&gt;
*Tailgating or other unwanted actions.&lt;br /&gt;
*Entry barcode scanner is broken or it is a stub.&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate in in the '''Fire Alarm''' or '''Emergency''' state. The alarm is produces as a repetitive pulse signal (700ms).&lt;br /&gt;
*Gate is open only for exit.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
After the Emergency State button pressed, the gate switches to the Emergency State. Then only exit from this state is to restart the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The signal can be set/received to/from a contact from any of the halves of the gate.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration Management==&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;User Interface&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Galaxy Gate is configured through the '''/configuration''' page. If the server is running at 192.168.1.221 and port is 8888, the url is:&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;http://192.168.1.221/configuration&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-configuration-main.png|zentriert|rahmenlos|configuration page]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;There are two buttons on the page:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
!Action&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Save'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Saves the modified configuration to the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Post&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|'''Reset'''&lt;br /&gt;
|Discards any changes by reloading the configuration from the server&lt;br /&gt;
|Get&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
The configuration is split into sections and subsections:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*General&lt;br /&gt;
**Dispatcher&lt;br /&gt;
**Miscellaneous&lt;br /&gt;
*Devices&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Barcode Reader Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Gate&lt;br /&gt;
**Tracking Camera&lt;br /&gt;
**Audio Player&lt;br /&gt;
**Camera&lt;br /&gt;
*Displays&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Gate Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Entry&lt;br /&gt;
**Display Exit&lt;br /&gt;
**Display TimeInfo&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Here are some screenshots:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-general.png|zentriert|904x904px]][[Datei:gg-barcode-reader-gate.png|zentriert|952x952px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-audio-player-camera.png|zentriert|841x841px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-tracking-camera.png|zentriert|809x809px]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-displays.png|zentriert|811x811px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
A subsection is often has a structure with a combo box named '''Type''' at the top and some fields that follow. This structure is used for configuring an entity that can have several implementations. What is important is that the implementation can differ in type and number of controls. For example, a simulator of the gate has only two properties:&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-gate-simulator.png|zentriert|810x810px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Architecture===&lt;br /&gt;
The picture below gives a bird's eye view of the configuration management.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:gg-architecture-configuration-management.png|zentriert|1150x1150px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
When the gate starts and the Configuration.json is present it is created from the Initial Configuration (base.py or other .py configuration file).&lt;br /&gt;
The Schema  contains a set of data for describing controls in form components:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Which controls should contain a component&lt;br /&gt;
*Validations rules if any&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
E.g. a form component can contain a text box and an input for integers. The data range for integer should 1-100.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
The Default Data contains the initial data for controls in form components.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Roadmap&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Roadmap===&lt;br /&gt;
The features are planned for the upcoming release:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
*Configurations page allows you to see the list of available configurations. You can:&lt;br /&gt;
**Clone an existing configuration to a new one&lt;br /&gt;
**Delete a configuration&lt;br /&gt;
**Make a configuration active. Only one configuration can be used by the server and it is called ''active''.&lt;br /&gt;
*Apply button. This should apply changes on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Restart button. This should restart the docker container and apply settings,  which cannot be applied on-the-fly.&lt;br /&gt;
*Extend the vue form generator library:&lt;br /&gt;
**Make the switch control consistent with the switch controls on other pages&lt;br /&gt;
**Add a control which allows you to manage an array of items (e.g. the list of connected gates). E.g. &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://codepen.io/safx/pen/AhCtk&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
*Import/Export of a Configuration.json.&lt;br /&gt;
*Reset any configuration to the default one (by removing the json file&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Management of Events==&lt;br /&gt;
The following sections contains the term '''Path''', which means the path is part of the URL. E.g., path '''/events''' for the FMCU Server running under '''&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;''' means&lt;br /&gt;
 &amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;https://server.maxcrc.de/events&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Events==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /events&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a filterable and sortable list of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Date&lt;br /&gt;
|Date and time when the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Translated name of the event&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate&lt;br /&gt;
|Gate if appropriate where the event occurred&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|State&lt;br /&gt;
|The state of the event if supported&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Additional info about the event&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definitions Page==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definitions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of definitions of events:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event Definition Groups&lt;br /&gt;
|Groups to which the event belongs to if any&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Supported States&lt;br /&gt;
|Can be empty (for impulse events) or '''On, Off''' (for the events with states)&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Category&lt;br /&gt;
|Category to which the event belongs to&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Definition Groups==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-definition-groups&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event groups:&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|Name&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Events&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definitions assigned to the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
An event definition group allows you to group one or more events so that it can be bound to a user group. See '''Event Subscriptions''' below&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Event Subscriptions==&lt;br /&gt;
Web path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /event-subscriptions&lt;br /&gt;
The page shows a list of event definition groups bound to a user groups.&lt;br /&gt;
{| class=&amp;quot;wikitable&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
!Name&lt;br /&gt;
!Description&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Group&lt;br /&gt;
|User group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|Event definition group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Locked&lt;br /&gt;
|When locked, events are not sent to the users of the group&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Info&lt;br /&gt;
|Any informative text&lt;br /&gt;
|-&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete&lt;br /&gt;
|Delete button&lt;br /&gt;
|}&lt;br /&gt;
When a event definition group is bound to a user group and not locked, new events from the event definition group are sent to the users from the user group. The user must have a valid email address.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Example. A user group '''Alarm events''' with two members '''user1''' and '''user2''' is bound to an event definition group '''Alarm events''' with two events '''GateTailgating''' and '''GateStateFireAlarm'''. When either or both of these events occur, both users '''user1''' and '''user2''' receive an email notification about that.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Edit this section&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
==Configuration==&lt;br /&gt;
Path:&lt;br /&gt;
 /configuration&lt;br /&gt;
In order the emails with events can be sent out, the '''Email''' section with the information like the hostname, port etc. of the outgoing server and credentials should be properly configured.&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=KAMBERI_GROUP&amp;diff=5795</id>
		<title>KAMBERI GROUP</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=KAMBERI_GROUP&amp;diff=5795"/>
		<updated>2021-11-10T10:30:03Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* Produktkategorien anlegen */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=='''Bedienungsanleitung'''==&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Eingangsautomat===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Herren Tageskarte¶(Barzahlung)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, Tageskarte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Tageskarte Herren2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Bargeld).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlart Bargeld.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, Barzahlung &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Barzahlung.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Herren Tageskarte ¶(Kartenzahlung)''' &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, Tageskarte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Tageskarte Herren2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Kartenzahlung).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Die einzelnen Schritte wiederholen sich bei allen weiteren Bezahlvorgängen. }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, bezahlen Sie mit ihrer EC oder Kreditkarte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung Karte2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Bezahlung bitte Karte entnehmen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte Karte entnehmen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''10er-Karte Herren ¶(Barzahlung)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, 10er Karte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung 10er Karte Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Bargeld).[[Datei:Bezahlart Bargeld.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, Barzahlung&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Barzahlung 10erKarte Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''10er-Karte Herren¶(Kartenzahlung)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, 10er Karte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung 10er Karte Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Kartenzahlung).[[Datei:Bezahlung Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, Kartenzahlung&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:10er Karte Bezahlung mit Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Bezahlung bitte Karte entnehmen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte Karte entnehmen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Check-In Ablauf 10er Karte Herren'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Automat zeigt ihnen nach dem Scannen der RFID-Karte eine Gesamtübersicht&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
und ihre restlichen Passagen. Drücken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Bezahlung&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Check In Herren 10er Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt &amp;quot;Vorgang Fertiggestellt&amp;quot; und können durch das Gate eintreten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Check IN Herren 10er Karte abgeschlossen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Check-In Ablauf Ladies Karte'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Automat zeigt ihnen nach dem Scannen der RFID-Karte eine Gesamtübersicht,&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
den Gesamtbetrag der zu bezahlen ist, die Produkte und die Gültigkeit der Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Bezahlung&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Check in Ladies2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Und wählen im Anschluss eine Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlart wählen2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Bezahlvorgang können Sie durch das Gate eintreten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Ausgangsautomat===&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:VU Ausgang.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;(''in Bearbeitung'').........&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
__________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Kasse Kartenausgabe===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====POS / RFID - Damen Karte freier Eintritt====&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücke Sie Button Damen Freier Eintritt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt1.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2,  bitte Scannen Sie eine RFID Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt2.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt3, drücken Sie den Button Bezahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt3.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Vorgang abgeschlossen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt4.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Jeglicher Zutritt nur mit vorherigem Check-In am Automaten möglich!&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
1. Check-In am Automat&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
2. Zutritt durch das Gate&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
3. Nur dann ist der Kauf von Produkten möglich. }}&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====POS / RFID - Karte Herren freier Eintritt====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos1.png|ohne|mini|289x289px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie dann das Produkt  RFID-Karte Herren kostenlos aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos2.png|ohne|mini|290x290px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Feld Kasse wird nun die kostenlose Herren Karte mit 0,00€ angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos4.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie nun auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos5.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint die Aufforderung Zahlung: 0,00 € bitte Karte scannen, &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
scannen Sie nun bitte die Master-Karte.[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint das folgende Fenster (der Kunde hat bezahlt).[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Jeglicher Zutritt nur mit vorherigem Check-In am Automaten möglich!&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
1. Check-In am Automat&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
2. Zutritt durch das Gate&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
3. Nur dann ist der Kauf von Produkten möglich. }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
______________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====POS / RFID - Karte Damen====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID Karte Damen aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartekostenlosPOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun ein Suchfeld angezeigt (Kunden suchen).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf die Lupe und es öffnet sich folgendes Fenster (Namensliste).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie aus der Namensliste nun die Dame welcher Sie die Karte zuordnen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Anschluss drücken Sie den Button  &amp;quot;Kunde auswählen &amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint die Aufforderung &amp;quot;Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS7.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Feld Kasse wird nun die kostenlose Damen Karte mit 0,00€ angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS8.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie nun auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS9.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint die Aufforderung Zahlung: 0,00 € bitte Karte scannen, &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint das folgende Fenster (der Kunde hat bezahlt).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Kasse Bar===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Produktverkauf====&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Ladebildschirm gelangen Sie auf die POS-Schnittstelle.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:POS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um eine Bestellung aufzugeben, wählen Sie zunächst den Produkttyp.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um Produkte aus einer anderen Kategorie auszuwählen, müssen Sie auf das Home-Symbol klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um die Menge eines Produkts zu erhöhen, müssen Sie mehrmals auf das Produkt klicken oder die Menge mit Hilfe der Zahlenleiste ändern.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können auch die Menge eines bereits hinzugefügten Produkts ändern, indem Sie es im Warenkorb markieren und dann den Ziffernblock verwenden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos7.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um ein Produkt aus dem Warenkorb zu entfernen, müssen Sie das Produkt markieren und dann auf dem Ziffernblock zweimal die Löschtaste drücken (bei einmaligem Drücken wird nur die Menge entfernt).&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie die Bestellung vollständig löschen möchten, wiederholen Sie den Vorgang, bis der Warenkorb leer ist.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos8.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Produkte in der Kategorie Champagner haben ein Bonus. Wenn Sie ein solches Produkt hinzufügen, werden Sie aufgefordert, eine Person auszuwählen, auf deren Konto der Bonus gutgeschrieben werden soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um eine Person auszuwählen, klicken Sie auf das Lupensymbol oder geben Sie einen Namen ein.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie dann aus der Liste die Person aus die den Bonus erhalten soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos11.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Danach klicken Sie bitte die Schaltfläche &amp;quot;Hinzufügen&amp;quot;. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn keine Notwendigkeit besteht, einen Bonus hinzuzufügen, überspringen Sie diesen Schritt, indem Sie auf die Schaltfläche &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;quot;Weiter &amp;quot; klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos13.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nachdem Sie eine Bestellung aufgegeben haben, müssen Sie diese bestätigen. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um Ihre Bestellung zu bestätigen, klicken Sie auf die Schaltfläche &amp;quot;Zahlung&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos14.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Scannen Sie dann bitte eine Kundenkarte. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos15.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn die Bestellung erfolgreich erstellt wurde, sehen Sie folgendes im Informationsfenster, das sich öffnet.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos16.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Durchführung Storno====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie haben ihre Kasse geöffnet und möchten ein Storno durchführen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Kunde im Beispiel hat einen Apfelsaft gekauft.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie bitte auf Storno.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich folgende Ansicht, hier drücken Sie bitte auf die Lupe.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun alle Produkte von diesem Tag angezeigt die Sie stornieren können.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie bitte auf Storno.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der nächsten Ansicht bekommen Sie das Produkt angezeigt was storniert werden soll. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie bitte auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno7.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt bitte Karte scannen. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Scannen Sie bitte die Karte auf der das Produkt storniert werden soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno8.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun folgendes zuerst angezeigt...&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
....und gleich im Anschluss&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Scannen Sie nun bitte die Supervisor-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Vorgang ist danach abgeschlossen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können dies wie folgt prüfen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 1&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie bitte auf Storno.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Und in der nächsten Ansicht wieder auf die Lupe.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun das hinter dem Produkt was Sie gerade storniert haben kein &amp;quot;STORNO&amp;quot; mehr steht.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 2&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf der Kasse auf RFID Info.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno13.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie die RFID Karte wo der Betrag wieder gutgeschrieben werden sollte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno14.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Kartenguthaben sehen Sie den Betrag auf der Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno15.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 3 (im Backend)&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen im Backend bei Bestellungen das die 3,50€ wieder Gutgeschrieben wurden.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno16.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 4&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der gleichen Ansicht können Sie auf den Minus Betrag drücken und bekommen dann&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
in der nächsten Ansicht unter Typ die Verkaufsrückerstattung angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Bestellung mit Spindnummer (Angemeldet ist ein Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie ein Produkt aus (z.B. Softgetränke).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt z.B. Coca Cola&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich folgendes PopUp.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie klicken bitte auf Spinde.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun ein Zahleneingabefeld&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Hier geben Sie die Spindnummer vom Kunden ein,&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
danach erscheint &amp;quot;Bitte scannen Sie die Supervisor Karte&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem scannen der Supervisor Karte, sehen Sie das gewählte Produkt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie drücken bitte auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt das der Kunde bezahlt hat.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Bestellung mit Spindnummer (Angemeldet ist ein Supervisor/Manager)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie ein Produkt aus (z.B. Softgetränke).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt z.B. Coca Cola&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich folgendes PopUp.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie klicken bitte auf Spinde.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun ein Zahleneingabefeld&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Hier geben Sie die Spindnummer vom Kunden ein&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen das gewählte Produkt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie drücken bitte auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt das der Kunde bezahlt hat.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Sobald-Sie-die-Zahlungsmethode-gewählt-haben-entnehmen-Sie-bitte-nach-dem-Bezahlvorgang-Ihre-Kredit--oder-Girokarte-Ihr-Wechselgeld-und-Ihre-Quittung-je-nach-Zahlungsmethode&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Mitarbeiter===&lt;br /&gt;
Mitarbeiter können ebenfalls an der Kasse Kartenausgabe verwaltet werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====RFID Personalkarte (Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin ist schon in der Namensliste hinterlegt)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Herren Karte 1.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID Personalkarte aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Personalkarte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun ein Suchfeld angezeigt (Kunden suchen).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ist der Mitarbeiter/die Mitarbeiterin  schon registriert drücken Sie auf die Lupe, &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
es öffnet sich folgendes Fenster: (Namensliste).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Aus der Namensliste wählen Sie nun den Mitarbeiter/die Mitarbeiterin aus welche die Karte erhalten soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Kunde auswählen.png|mini|ohne]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine neue RFID-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem scannen der Karte sehen Sie auf der Kassenansicht das gewählte Produkt&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(inkl. der Inhalte), drücken Sie nun auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Personalkarte bezahlen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Kunde hat bezahlt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
___________________________________________________________________________________________                &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====RFID Personalkarte (Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin ist noch nicht erfasst)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Herren Karte 1.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID Personalkarte aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Personalkarte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun folgende Ansicht: (bitte auf die Abb. Figur mit dem + Zeichen klicken).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun folgende Ansicht: (legen Sie hier nun den Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin an).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nachdem Sie alle erforderlichen Felder ausgefüllt haben klicken Sie bitte auf  Speichern.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie nun auf Kunde Auswählen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Wiederholen Sie bitte ab hier die Schritte aus der Anleitung. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Die einzelnen Schritte wiederholen sich bei allen weiteren RFID- Personalkarten ( Personalleiter, Supervisor und Lady-Karte) }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Registrierung Damen===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Registrierungsablauf====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie '''Registrieren''' aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Registrieren auf dem Tablet.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Erfassen Sie die notwendigen Daten, am Ende bestätigen Sie bitte mit WEITER.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte auswählen:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ich nehme am Düsseldorfer Verfahren teil und beauftrage den Betreiber die Tagespauschale an das Finanzamt abzuführen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
oder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ich nehme nicht am Düsseldorfer Verfahren teil.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bestätigung der AGB und Datenschutzhinweise nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Registrieren auf dem Tablet2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Spinde===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Spinde nach Kontrolle und Reinigung durch Fachpersonal====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Beispiel:''' &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
18 Spinde sind nach Nutzung durch den Kunden noch nicht wieder freigegeben.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
3 Spinde sind schon wieder (grün) und freigegeben.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:spinde1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie nach der Reinigung und Kontrolle einfach mit der linken Maustaste einmal auf die Spind Nummer die wieder &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
freigegeben werden soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:spinde2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Spind 4 und 5 nach Freigabe durch Fachpersonal.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:spinde3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Backendverwaltung===&lt;br /&gt;
Im Backend können nur Aufgaben entsprechend der vergebenen Berechtigungsstruktur erfolgen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Auswertung Kartennutzungen====&lt;br /&gt;
'''1. Anmeldung im Backend'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Melden Sie sich mit Ihren Zugangsdaten die Sie erhalten haben im Backend an:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:AnmeldungBackend.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Anmeldung öffnet sich folgendes Fenster: Sie klicken bitte die kleine Kachel oben links an.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:AnmeldungBackend1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun folgendes Bild angezeigt: (Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendnachAnmeldung.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''2. Produktauswertung einer Karte (am Beispiel Herren)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteVerkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. Hier unter Verkauf die Liste öffnen und dann Produkte anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteVerkauf2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produkte angezeigt, hier geben Sie im Suchfeld z.B. &amp;quot;Herren&amp;quot; ein.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteKarteBeispielHerren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun in dieser Ansicht alle Produkte angezeigt die das Wort &amp;quot;Herren&amp;quot; enthalten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie im Beispielfall das Produkt Herren 50,00 € aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produkte/Herren angezeigt, hier klicken Sie bitte auf Ticket.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der nächsten Ansicht klicken Sie bitte auf Card Gentlemen Template.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der Ansicht Produkte/Herren/Card Gentlemen Template klicken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Additional Products&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun eine Liste aller Produkte auf der Herren Karte angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''3. Gültigkeit einer Karte'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gültigkeit einer Damen oder Herren Karte. Klicken Sie auf Tickets&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:GültigkeitTicket1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun folgende Ansicht &amp;quot;Tickets&amp;quot;- in der Liste sehen Sie das Produkt Ladies.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Eine Gültigkeitsdauer, unter von-Zu wird nicht angezeigt, weil eine Ladies Karte nach dem Eintritt ihre Gültigkeit bis zum Austritt behält.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:GültigkeitTicket2Damen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gültigkeit einer Herren Karte. Klicken Sie wie Abb. oben auf Tickets, Sie bekommen dann die gleiche Liste angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Eine Herren Karte ist immer 24 Stunden gültig oder bis zum Austritt des Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:GültigkeitTicket2Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''4. Spind Nummer einer Karte'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Spinde.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:SpindeBackend.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Spinde angezeigt:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen in der Ansicht die Spind Nummern, den Zustand, die Größe, die Kartennummer und gereinigt am, so wie aktiviert oder nicht aktiviert angezeigt. Über die einzelnen Überschriften können Sie auch sortieren.[[Datei:AnsichtSpinde.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''5. Karte deaktivieren'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf RFID-Karten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Lady Karte deaktivieren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen jetzt alle registrierten Karten angezeigt, wählen Sie hier die Karte aus die deaktiviert werden soll. &lt;br /&gt;
Sie können hierzu die Karten Nummer, die EAN Nr., Type, Partner oder Ausgabedatum anklicken.  &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren1.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Nun sehen Sie den aufgerufenen Datensatz, klicken Sie hier bitte '''&amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;'''. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren2.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt klicken Sie bitte auf '''&amp;quot;Verfallsdatum Deaktiviert&amp;quot;'''., und im Anschluss auf &amp;quot;'''Speichern'''&amp;quot;. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren2a.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Jetzt ist die Karte deaktiviert, Sie können dies mit einem Schritt zurück überprüfen. &lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hierzu bitte auf &amp;quot;'''Registrierte Karten'''&amp;quot;.  &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren4.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun bei dem Datensatz welchen Sie zuvor gewählt hatten in der Spalte &amp;quot;Deaktiviert&amp;quot; einen Haken.  &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren5.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''6. Bei Verlust einer Karte (Kartendaten übertragen auf die die neue Karte)'''         &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend PoS-Produktkategorien anlegen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Kasse.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image17.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Kasse angezeigt. Hier bitte unter Konfiguration, '''PoS-Produktkategorien''' wählen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht PoS-Produktkategorien angezeigt. Hier bitte oben links '''&amp;quot;Anlegen&amp;quot;''' wählen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Fenster was sich öffnet tragen Sie den Namen der Produktkategorie und eine Nummer für die Reihenfolge ein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#(im Beispiel Zigaretten).&lt;br /&gt;
#Nummer/Reihenfolge.&lt;br /&gt;
#Speichern&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Speichern wählen Sie bitte wieder '''PoS-Produktkategorien.'''&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image21.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun in der Liste PoS-Produktkategorien das neue Produkt Zigaretten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image22.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Wenn Sie bei den Produkten etwas verändert, hinzugefügt oder gelöscht haben müssen Sie bitte das POS nach den Veränderungen NEU STARTEN , da ihre Änderungen sonst nicht an das POS übertragen werden. }}_______________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend PoS-Produktkategorien löschen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Kasse.[[Datei:image17.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Kasse angezeigt. Hier bitte unter Konfiguration, '''PoS-Produktkategorien''' wählen.[[Datei:image18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht PoS-Produktkategorien angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier wählen Sie wieder das Beispiel Zigaretten.[[Datei:image22.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun das angelegte Produkt angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier wählen Sie Aktion und dann &amp;quot;Löschen&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image23.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen dann nochmal einen Hinweis angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ob Sie den Datensatz wirklich löschen möchten?&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie mit OK bestätigen ist der Datensatz gelöscht.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image24.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Überprüfung ob der Datensatz wirklich gelöscht wurde.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie wählen erneut '''PoS-Produktkategorien.'''&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image25.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''In der Liste die Sie jetzt angezeigt bekommen sollte das gelöschte Produkt (im Beispiel Zigaretten)''' &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''nicht mehr angezeigt werden.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Produktkategorien anlegen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier unter Konfiguration die Liste öffnen und dann '''Produktkategorien''' anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image26.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produktkategorien angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier wählen Sie oben links &amp;quot;Anlegen&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image27.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können nun eine neue Produktkategorie anlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(im Beispiel Kondome)&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hierzu gehen Sie wie folgt vor:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Sie tragen den Kategoriennamen ein.&lt;br /&gt;
#Bei Oberkategorie wählen Sie ALLE aus.&lt;br /&gt;
#Speichern nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
#Alles andere ist vor eingestellt und muss nicht verändert werden wenn es dazu keinen Anlass gibt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image29.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Speichern prüfen Sie bitte selbst ob ihre neue Produktkategorie angelegt wurde.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Dazu wählen Sie einfach nach dem Speichern '''Produktkatgorien'''.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image30.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun am Ende der Liste ihre neu angelegte Produktkategorie.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image31.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
__________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Produktkategorien ändern oder löschen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier unter Konfiguration die Liste öffnen und dann '''Produktkategorien''' anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image26.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produktkategorien angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie wählen einfach die Produktkategorie aus die Sie ändern oder löschen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(im Beispiel Kondome)&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image31.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun das Bearbeitungsfenster angezeigt (wie schon beim anlegen einer neuen Produktkategorie).&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie oben links 1. wählen können Sie die Produktkategorie bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Die Schritte danach sind die gleichen wie beim anlegen einer neuen Produktkategorie&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter 2. Aktion können Sie die Produktkategorie löschen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image32.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie löschen gewählt haben werden Sie nochmal gefragt ob Sie den Datensatz wirklich löschen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image33.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Auswahl '''OK''' können Sie wieder selbst prüfen ob die Produktkategorie gelöscht wurde.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie wählen dazu einfach oben links wieder Produktkategorien und gelangen so zur Liste.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der Liste sollte der Eintrag Kondome nun fehlen und wurde somit erfolgreich gelöscht.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image34.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
___________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Produkte anlegen/ hinzufügen und ausblenden, MwSt. Satz eintragen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier unter Verkauf die Liste öffnen und dann '''Produkte''' anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image11.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produkte angezeigt. Hier bitte auf &amp;quot;'''Anlegen'''&amp;quot; klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteVerkauf3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen dann folgende Ansicht angezeigt und können nun hier, neue Produkte hinzufügen, in Kategorien einteilen, die Produktart wählen und den Verkaufspreis festlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Beispiel'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Die Felder die ausgefüllt werden müssen sind alles '''MUSS''' Felder und '''KEINE''' kann Felder!&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gehen Sie bitte Schritt für Schritt vor.....&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Produktbezeichnung eintragen (im Beispiel Chef Salat).&lt;br /&gt;
#Häkchen bei- Kann verkauft werden '''MUSS''' gesetzt sein. ''(&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;fehlt dieses Häkchen wird das Produkt nicht auf dem POS angezeig&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;t).''&lt;br /&gt;
#Häkchen bei- Kann eingekauft werden '''MUSS''' gesetzt sein.                                                                                                                                       &amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Reiter Allgemeine Informationen &amp;lt;&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
#Produktart '''MUSS''' ausgewählt werden (im Beispiel Dienstleistung).&lt;br /&gt;
#Interne Referenz '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden (im Beispiel 11).&lt;br /&gt;
#Interne Kategorie '''MUSS''' ausgewählt werden (im Beispiel Alle/Speisen).&lt;br /&gt;
#Verkaufspreis '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.[[Datei:image12.png|ohne|mini|627x627px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Reiter Verkauf &amp;lt;&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Häkchen bei- Verfügbar am Point Of Sale '''MUSS''' gesetzt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
#Point of Sale Kategorie '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden. (im Beispiel, Speisen).[[Datei:image14.png|ohne|mini|591x591px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
#&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Im Reiter Abrechnung &amp;lt; (''hier wird auch die MwSt. eingetragen oder angepasst'')&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
##Steuern (Verkauf) '''MUSS''' die Umsatzsteuer eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
##Steuern (Einkauf) '''MUSS''' die Vorsteuer eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
##Fakturierungsregel- '''MUSS''' Rechnung bei Auftrag angeklickt werden.[[Datei:image15.png|ohne|mini|568x568px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Reiter Ticket &amp;lt;&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
###Reihenfolge '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Ticket Display Name '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Print Name '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Lock Timeout (Sec) '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Ticket Template '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.[[Datei:image16.png|ohne|mini|514x514px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende bitte oben links &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot; nicht vergessen.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Wenn Sie bei den Produkten etwas verändert, hinzugefügt oder gelöscht haben müssen Sie bitte das POS nach den Veränderungen NEU STARTEN , da ihre Änderungen sonst nicht an das POS übertragen werden. }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie möchten ein Produkt welches Sie nicht mehr verkaufen ausblenden,...gehen Sie bitte wie folgt vor:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt welches Sie nicht mehr verkaufen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt ausblenden.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie bitte auf das Feld &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt ausblenden1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Dann entfernen Sie bitte den Haken bei &amp;quot;Kann verkauft werden&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt ausblenden2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende oben links bitte &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Ersatz- oder neue Produkte hinzufügen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächste Seite dem &amp;quot;Armaturenbrett&amp;quot; öffnen Sie bitte Ersatzprodukte- Alle&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Ersatzprodukte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun folgende Liste angezeigt &amp;quot;Ersatzproduktgruppe&amp;quot; klicken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Anlegen&amp;quot;:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Ersatzproduktgruppe.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun Ersatzproduktgruppe/NEU angezeigt und können hier jetzt ihre Produkte/Ersatzprodukte anlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ErsatzproduktgruppeNEU.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende oben links bitte &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie möchten in der Ersatzproduktgruppe schon bestehende Gruppen/Produkte ändern, dann gehen Sie wie folgt vor:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie bitte die Gruppe aus welche Sie ändern möchten indem Sie diese direkt anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Ersatzproduktgruppe ändern.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Fenster bitte oben links &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot; anklicken, danach können Sie die Gruppe/Produkte bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Bearbeitung klicken Sie oben links bitte wieder auf  &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_______________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
====Produktzuordnung Damen Provision====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächste Seite dem &amp;quot;Armaturenbrett&amp;quot; öffnen Sie bitte unter &amp;quot;Cashback&amp;quot;  Produkt-Cashback.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Armaturenbrett.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächsten Seite &amp;quot;Produkt-Cahsback&amp;quot; klicken Sie bitte auf das Produkt wo Sie den Cashback angezeigt bekommen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt Cashback2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächsten Seite klicken Sie auf &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;, im Anschluss können Sie die Daten bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt Cashback3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende oben links bitte &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_______________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________ &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/ Karten Historie====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf RFID-Karten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Historie1a.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Registrierte Karten angezeigt. Hier bitte auf &amp;quot; '''Karten-Aktionen'''&amp;quot; und im Anschluss auf &amp;quot;'''Kartenbericht klicken'''&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Historie2a.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich RFID-Kartenbericht erstellen, hier geben Sie bitte eine Karten- oder Spind Nummer ein: und klicken im Anschluss auf Erzeugen Sie:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Historie3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Jetzt bekommen Sie den Bericht angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten HistorieBericht.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Personen anlegen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Partners.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiteranlegenbackend.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Liste Partners angezeigt, hier klicken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;'''Anlegen'''&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiteranlegenbackend1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun Partner/Neu angezeigt und können jetzt hier die jeweilige Person/Personen anlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiteranlegenbackend2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Am Ende Speichern oben links bitte nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt öffnen Sie bitte eine Kassensitzung '''&amp;quot;KARTENAUSGABE'''&amp;quot;.[[Datei:BackendPOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Kasse Kartenausgabe &amp;quot;'''Neue Sitzung'''&amp;quot; (wenn vorher noch keine geöffnet war). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Kasse Kartenausgabe.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 [[Datei:RFID Karte Personal.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Lady Karte.png|ohne|mini|309x309px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Lady anlegen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Elke Brenner anlegen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine neue RFID Karte.[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Anschluss sehen Sie das ausgewählte Produkt, bestätigen Sie bitte mit Zahlung:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Lady Karte Kasse x.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nachdem Sie Zahlung angeklickt haben bitte mit der Supervisor Karte bestätigen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Die Person ist nun im System angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Personen deaktivieren====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Kassensitzung====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf  Point of Sale (POS).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendPOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Kassen angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Je nachdem welche Kasse Sie jetzt öffnen möchten klicken Sie auf der jeweiligen Kasse &amp;quot;'''Neue Sitzung'''&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(Beispiel 1, Kasse).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendPOS2 - Kopie.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich die Kasse.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendPOS3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===MwSt. Satz eintragen, verändern und anzeigen.===&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf Verkauf.[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Öffnen Sie unter Verkauf den Reiter &amp;quot;Konfiguration&amp;quot; und klicken dann bitte auf &amp;quot;Produktkategorien&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:MwSt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie in der Liste die sich geöffnet hat z.B. auf Alle/Säfte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produktkategorien1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun das Produkt Säfte und klicken hier bitte auf  &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Säfte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie nun die MwSt. bearbeiten, anpassen, ändern.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Steuer bearbeiten.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte am Ende des Vorgangs oben links &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot; nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Backend/Ticketnutzung===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Backend/Spindnutzung===&lt;br /&gt;
{{Links | Thema1 = }}&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=KAMBERI_GROUP&amp;diff=5793</id>
		<title>KAMBERI GROUP</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=KAMBERI_GROUP&amp;diff=5793"/>
		<updated>2021-11-10T10:28:25Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=='''Bedienungsanleitung'''==&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Eingangsautomat===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Herren Tageskarte¶(Barzahlung)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, Tageskarte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Tageskarte Herren2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Bargeld).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlart Bargeld.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, Barzahlung &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Barzahlung.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Herren Tageskarte ¶(Kartenzahlung)''' &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, Tageskarte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Tageskarte Herren2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Kartenzahlung).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Die einzelnen Schritte wiederholen sich bei allen weiteren Bezahlvorgängen. }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, bezahlen Sie mit ihrer EC oder Kreditkarte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung Karte2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Bezahlung bitte Karte entnehmen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte Karte entnehmen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''10er-Karte Herren ¶(Barzahlung)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, 10er Karte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung 10er Karte Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Bargeld).[[Datei:Bezahlart Bargeld.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, Barzahlung&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Barzahlung 10erKarte Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''10er-Karte Herren¶(Kartenzahlung)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, 10er Karte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung 10er Karte Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Kartenzahlung).[[Datei:Bezahlung Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, Kartenzahlung&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:10er Karte Bezahlung mit Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Bezahlung bitte Karte entnehmen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte Karte entnehmen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Check-In Ablauf 10er Karte Herren'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Automat zeigt ihnen nach dem Scannen der RFID-Karte eine Gesamtübersicht&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
und ihre restlichen Passagen. Drücken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Bezahlung&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Check In Herren 10er Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt &amp;quot;Vorgang Fertiggestellt&amp;quot; und können durch das Gate eintreten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Check IN Herren 10er Karte abgeschlossen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Check-In Ablauf Ladies Karte'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Automat zeigt ihnen nach dem Scannen der RFID-Karte eine Gesamtübersicht,&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
den Gesamtbetrag der zu bezahlen ist, die Produkte und die Gültigkeit der Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Bezahlung&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Check in Ladies2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Und wählen im Anschluss eine Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlart wählen2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Bezahlvorgang können Sie durch das Gate eintreten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Ausgangsautomat===&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:VU Ausgang.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;(''in Bearbeitung'').........&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
__________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Kasse Kartenausgabe===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====POS / RFID - Damen Karte freier Eintritt====&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücke Sie Button Damen Freier Eintritt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt1.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2,  bitte Scannen Sie eine RFID Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt2.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt3, drücken Sie den Button Bezahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt3.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Vorgang abgeschlossen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt4.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Jeglicher Zutritt nur mit vorherigem Check-In am Automaten möglich!&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
1. Check-In am Automat&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
2. Zutritt durch das Gate&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
3. Nur dann ist der Kauf von Produkten möglich. }}&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====POS / RFID - Karte Herren freier Eintritt====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos1.png|ohne|mini|289x289px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie dann das Produkt  RFID-Karte Herren kostenlos aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos2.png|ohne|mini|290x290px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Feld Kasse wird nun die kostenlose Herren Karte mit 0,00€ angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos4.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie nun auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos5.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint die Aufforderung Zahlung: 0,00 € bitte Karte scannen, &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
scannen Sie nun bitte die Master-Karte.[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint das folgende Fenster (der Kunde hat bezahlt).[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Jeglicher Zutritt nur mit vorherigem Check-In am Automaten möglich!&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
1. Check-In am Automat&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
2. Zutritt durch das Gate&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
3. Nur dann ist der Kauf von Produkten möglich. }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
______________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====POS / RFID - Karte Damen====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID Karte Damen aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartekostenlosPOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun ein Suchfeld angezeigt (Kunden suchen).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf die Lupe und es öffnet sich folgendes Fenster (Namensliste).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie aus der Namensliste nun die Dame welcher Sie die Karte zuordnen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Anschluss drücken Sie den Button  &amp;quot;Kunde auswählen &amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint die Aufforderung &amp;quot;Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS7.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Feld Kasse wird nun die kostenlose Damen Karte mit 0,00€ angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS8.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie nun auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS9.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint die Aufforderung Zahlung: 0,00 € bitte Karte scannen, &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint das folgende Fenster (der Kunde hat bezahlt).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Kasse Bar===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Produktverkauf====&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Ladebildschirm gelangen Sie auf die POS-Schnittstelle.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:POS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um eine Bestellung aufzugeben, wählen Sie zunächst den Produkttyp.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um Produkte aus einer anderen Kategorie auszuwählen, müssen Sie auf das Home-Symbol klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um die Menge eines Produkts zu erhöhen, müssen Sie mehrmals auf das Produkt klicken oder die Menge mit Hilfe der Zahlenleiste ändern.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können auch die Menge eines bereits hinzugefügten Produkts ändern, indem Sie es im Warenkorb markieren und dann den Ziffernblock verwenden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos7.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um ein Produkt aus dem Warenkorb zu entfernen, müssen Sie das Produkt markieren und dann auf dem Ziffernblock zweimal die Löschtaste drücken (bei einmaligem Drücken wird nur die Menge entfernt).&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie die Bestellung vollständig löschen möchten, wiederholen Sie den Vorgang, bis der Warenkorb leer ist.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos8.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Produkte in der Kategorie Champagner haben ein Bonus. Wenn Sie ein solches Produkt hinzufügen, werden Sie aufgefordert, eine Person auszuwählen, auf deren Konto der Bonus gutgeschrieben werden soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um eine Person auszuwählen, klicken Sie auf das Lupensymbol oder geben Sie einen Namen ein.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie dann aus der Liste die Person aus die den Bonus erhalten soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos11.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Danach klicken Sie bitte die Schaltfläche &amp;quot;Hinzufügen&amp;quot;. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn keine Notwendigkeit besteht, einen Bonus hinzuzufügen, überspringen Sie diesen Schritt, indem Sie auf die Schaltfläche &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;quot;Weiter &amp;quot; klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos13.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nachdem Sie eine Bestellung aufgegeben haben, müssen Sie diese bestätigen. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um Ihre Bestellung zu bestätigen, klicken Sie auf die Schaltfläche &amp;quot;Zahlung&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos14.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Scannen Sie dann bitte eine Kundenkarte. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos15.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn die Bestellung erfolgreich erstellt wurde, sehen Sie folgendes im Informationsfenster, das sich öffnet.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos16.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Durchführung Storno====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie haben ihre Kasse geöffnet und möchten ein Storno durchführen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Kunde im Beispiel hat einen Apfelsaft gekauft.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie bitte auf Storno.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich folgende Ansicht, hier drücken Sie bitte auf die Lupe.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun alle Produkte von diesem Tag angezeigt die Sie stornieren können.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie bitte auf Storno.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der nächsten Ansicht bekommen Sie das Produkt angezeigt was storniert werden soll. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie bitte auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno7.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt bitte Karte scannen. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Scannen Sie bitte die Karte auf der das Produkt storniert werden soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno8.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun folgendes zuerst angezeigt...&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
....und gleich im Anschluss&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Scannen Sie nun bitte die Supervisor-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Vorgang ist danach abgeschlossen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können dies wie folgt prüfen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 1&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie bitte auf Storno.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Und in der nächsten Ansicht wieder auf die Lupe.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun das hinter dem Produkt was Sie gerade storniert haben kein &amp;quot;STORNO&amp;quot; mehr steht.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 2&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf der Kasse auf RFID Info.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno13.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie die RFID Karte wo der Betrag wieder gutgeschrieben werden sollte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno14.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Kartenguthaben sehen Sie den Betrag auf der Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno15.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 3 (im Backend)&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen im Backend bei Bestellungen das die 3,50€ wieder Gutgeschrieben wurden.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno16.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 4&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der gleichen Ansicht können Sie auf den Minus Betrag drücken und bekommen dann&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
in der nächsten Ansicht unter Typ die Verkaufsrückerstattung angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Bestellung mit Spindnummer (Angemeldet ist ein Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie ein Produkt aus (z.B. Softgetränke).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt z.B. Coca Cola&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich folgendes PopUp.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie klicken bitte auf Spinde.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun ein Zahleneingabefeld&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Hier geben Sie die Spindnummer vom Kunden ein,&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
danach erscheint &amp;quot;Bitte scannen Sie die Supervisor Karte&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem scannen der Supervisor Karte, sehen Sie das gewählte Produkt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie drücken bitte auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt das der Kunde bezahlt hat.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Bestellung mit Spindnummer (Angemeldet ist ein Supervisor/Manager)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie ein Produkt aus (z.B. Softgetränke).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt z.B. Coca Cola&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich folgendes PopUp.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie klicken bitte auf Spinde.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun ein Zahleneingabefeld&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Hier geben Sie die Spindnummer vom Kunden ein&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen das gewählte Produkt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie drücken bitte auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt das der Kunde bezahlt hat.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Sobald-Sie-die-Zahlungsmethode-gewählt-haben-entnehmen-Sie-bitte-nach-dem-Bezahlvorgang-Ihre-Kredit--oder-Girokarte-Ihr-Wechselgeld-und-Ihre-Quittung-je-nach-Zahlungsmethode&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Mitarbeiter===&lt;br /&gt;
Mitarbeiter können ebenfalls an der Kasse Kartenausgabe verwaltet werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====RFID Personalkarte (Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin ist schon in der Namensliste hinterlegt)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Herren Karte 1.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID Personalkarte aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Personalkarte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun ein Suchfeld angezeigt (Kunden suchen).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ist der Mitarbeiter/die Mitarbeiterin  schon registriert drücken Sie auf die Lupe, &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
es öffnet sich folgendes Fenster: (Namensliste).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Aus der Namensliste wählen Sie nun den Mitarbeiter/die Mitarbeiterin aus welche die Karte erhalten soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Kunde auswählen.png|mini|ohne]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine neue RFID-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem scannen der Karte sehen Sie auf der Kassenansicht das gewählte Produkt&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(inkl. der Inhalte), drücken Sie nun auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Personalkarte bezahlen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Kunde hat bezahlt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
___________________________________________________________________________________________                &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====RFID Personalkarte (Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin ist noch nicht erfasst)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Herren Karte 1.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID Personalkarte aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Personalkarte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun folgende Ansicht: (bitte auf die Abb. Figur mit dem + Zeichen klicken).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun folgende Ansicht: (legen Sie hier nun den Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin an).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nachdem Sie alle erforderlichen Felder ausgefüllt haben klicken Sie bitte auf  Speichern.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie nun auf Kunde Auswählen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Wiederholen Sie bitte ab hier die Schritte aus der Anleitung. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Die einzelnen Schritte wiederholen sich bei allen weiteren RFID- Personalkarten ( Personalleiter, Supervisor und Lady-Karte) }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Registrierung Damen===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Registrierungsablauf====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie '''Registrieren''' aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Registrieren auf dem Tablet.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Erfassen Sie die notwendigen Daten, am Ende bestätigen Sie bitte mit WEITER.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte auswählen:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ich nehme am Düsseldorfer Verfahren teil und beauftrage den Betreiber die Tagespauschale an das Finanzamt abzuführen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
oder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ich nehme nicht am Düsseldorfer Verfahren teil.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bestätigung der AGB und Datenschutzhinweise nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Registrieren auf dem Tablet2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Spinde===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Spinde nach Kontrolle und Reinigung durch Fachpersonal====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Beispiel:''' &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
18 Spinde sind nach Nutzung durch den Kunden noch nicht wieder freigegeben.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
3 Spinde sind schon wieder (grün) und freigegeben.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:spinde1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie nach der Reinigung und Kontrolle einfach mit der linken Maustaste einmal auf die Spind Nummer die wieder &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
freigegeben werden soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:spinde2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Spind 4 und 5 nach Freigabe durch Fachpersonal.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:spinde3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Backendverwaltung===&lt;br /&gt;
Im Backend können nur Aufgaben entsprechend der vergebenen Berechtigungsstruktur erfolgen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Auswertung Kartennutzungen====&lt;br /&gt;
'''1. Anmeldung im Backend'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Melden Sie sich mit Ihren Zugangsdaten die Sie erhalten haben im Backend an:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:AnmeldungBackend.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Anmeldung öffnet sich folgendes Fenster: Sie klicken bitte die kleine Kachel oben links an.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:AnmeldungBackend1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun folgendes Bild angezeigt: (Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendnachAnmeldung.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''2. Produktauswertung einer Karte (am Beispiel Herren)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteVerkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. Hier unter Verkauf die Liste öffnen und dann Produkte anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteVerkauf2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produkte angezeigt, hier geben Sie im Suchfeld z.B. &amp;quot;Herren&amp;quot; ein.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteKarteBeispielHerren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun in dieser Ansicht alle Produkte angezeigt die das Wort &amp;quot;Herren&amp;quot; enthalten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie im Beispielfall das Produkt Herren 50,00 € aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produkte/Herren angezeigt, hier klicken Sie bitte auf Ticket.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der nächsten Ansicht klicken Sie bitte auf Card Gentlemen Template.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der Ansicht Produkte/Herren/Card Gentlemen Template klicken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Additional Products&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun eine Liste aller Produkte auf der Herren Karte angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''3. Gültigkeit einer Karte'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gültigkeit einer Damen oder Herren Karte. Klicken Sie auf Tickets&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:GültigkeitTicket1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun folgende Ansicht &amp;quot;Tickets&amp;quot;- in der Liste sehen Sie das Produkt Ladies.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Eine Gültigkeitsdauer, unter von-Zu wird nicht angezeigt, weil eine Ladies Karte nach dem Eintritt ihre Gültigkeit bis zum Austritt behält.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:GültigkeitTicket2Damen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gültigkeit einer Herren Karte. Klicken Sie wie Abb. oben auf Tickets, Sie bekommen dann die gleiche Liste angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Eine Herren Karte ist immer 24 Stunden gültig oder bis zum Austritt des Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:GültigkeitTicket2Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''4. Spind Nummer einer Karte'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Spinde.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:SpindeBackend.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Spinde angezeigt:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen in der Ansicht die Spind Nummern, den Zustand, die Größe, die Kartennummer und gereinigt am, so wie aktiviert oder nicht aktiviert angezeigt. Über die einzelnen Überschriften können Sie auch sortieren.[[Datei:AnsichtSpinde.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''5. Karte deaktivieren'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf RFID-Karten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Lady Karte deaktivieren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen jetzt alle registrierten Karten angezeigt, wählen Sie hier die Karte aus die deaktiviert werden soll. &lt;br /&gt;
Sie können hierzu die Karten Nummer, die EAN Nr., Type, Partner oder Ausgabedatum anklicken.  &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren1.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Nun sehen Sie den aufgerufenen Datensatz, klicken Sie hier bitte '''&amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;'''. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren2.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt klicken Sie bitte auf '''&amp;quot;Verfallsdatum Deaktiviert&amp;quot;'''., und im Anschluss auf &amp;quot;'''Speichern'''&amp;quot;. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren2a.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Jetzt ist die Karte deaktiviert, Sie können dies mit einem Schritt zurück überprüfen. &lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hierzu bitte auf &amp;quot;'''Registrierte Karten'''&amp;quot;.  &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren4.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun bei dem Datensatz welchen Sie zuvor gewählt hatten in der Spalte &amp;quot;Deaktiviert&amp;quot; einen Haken.  &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren5.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''6. Bei Verlust einer Karte (Kartendaten übertragen auf die die neue Karte)'''         &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend PoS-Produktkategorien anlegen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Kasse.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image17.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Kasse angezeigt. Hier bitte unter Konfiguration, '''PoS-Produktkategorien''' wählen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht PoS-Produktkategorien angezeigt. Hier bitte oben links '''&amp;quot;Anlegen&amp;quot;''' wählen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Fenster was sich öffnet tragen Sie den Namen der Produktkategorie und eine Nummer für die Reihenfolge ein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#(im Beispiel Zigaretten).&lt;br /&gt;
#Nummer/Reihenfolge.&lt;br /&gt;
#Speichern&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Speichern wählen Sie bitte wieder '''PoS-Produktkategorien.'''&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image21.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun in der Liste PoS-Produktkategorien das neue Produkt Zigaretten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image22.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Wenn Sie bei den Produkten etwas verändert, hinzugefügt oder gelöscht haben müssen Sie bitte das POS nach den Veränderungen NEU STARTEN , da ihre Änderungen sonst nicht an das POS übertragen werden. }}_______________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend PoS-Produktkategorien löschen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Kasse.[[Datei:image17.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Kasse angezeigt. Hier bitte unter Konfiguration, '''PoS-Produktkategorien''' wählen.[[Datei:image18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht PoS-Produktkategorien angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier wählen Sie wieder das Beispiel Zigaretten.[[Datei:image22.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun das angelegte Produkt angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier wählen Sie Aktion und dann &amp;quot;Löschen&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image23.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen dann nochmal einen Hinweis angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ob Sie den Datensatz wirklich löschen möchten?&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie mit OK bestätigen ist der Datensatz gelöscht.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image24.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Überprüfung ob der Datensatz wirklich gelöscht wurde.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie wählen erneut '''PoS-Produktkategorien.'''&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image25.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''In der Liste die Sie jetzt angezeigt bekommen sollte das gelöschte Produkt (im Beispiel Zigaretten)''' &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''nicht mehr angezeigt werden.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====  '''Produktkategorien anlegen''' ====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier unter Konfiguration die Liste öffnen und dann '''Produktkategorien''' anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image26.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produktkategorien angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier wählen Sie oben links &amp;quot;Anlegen&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image27.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können nun eine neue Produktkategorie anlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(im Beispiel Kondome)&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hierzu gehen Sie wie folgt vor:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Sie tragen den Kategoriennamen ein.&lt;br /&gt;
#Bei Oberkategorie wählen Sie ALLE aus.&lt;br /&gt;
#Speichern nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
#Alles andere ist vor eingestellt und muss nicht verändert werden wenn es dazu keinen Anlass gibt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image29.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Speichern prüfen Sie bitte selbst ob ihre neue Produktkategorie angelegt wurde.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Dazu wählen Sie einfach nach dem Speichern '''Produktkatgorien'''.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image30.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun am Ende der Liste ihre neu angelegte Produktkategorie.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image31.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
__________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====  '''Produktkategorien ändern oder löschen''' ====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier unter Konfiguration die Liste öffnen und dann '''Produktkategorien''' anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image26.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produktkategorien angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie wählen einfach die Produktkategorie aus die Sie ändern oder löschen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(im Beispiel Kondome)&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image31.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun das Bearbeitungsfenster angezeigt (wie schon beim anlegen einer neuen Produktkategorie).&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie oben links 1. wählen können Sie die Produktkategorie bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Die Schritte danach sind die gleichen wie beim anlegen einer neuen Produktkategorie&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter 2. Aktion können Sie die Produktkategorie löschen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image32.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie löschen gewählt haben werden Sie nochmal gefragt ob Sie den Datensatz wirklich löschen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image33.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Auswahl '''OK''' können Sie wieder selbst prüfen ob die Produktkategorie gelöscht wurde.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie wählen dazu einfach oben links wieder Produktkategorien und gelangen so zur Liste.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der Liste sollte der Eintrag Kondome nun fehlen und wurde somit erfolgreich gelöscht.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image34.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
___________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Produkte anlegen/ hinzufügen und ausblenden, MwSt. Satz eintragen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier unter Verkauf die Liste öffnen und dann '''Produkte''' anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image11.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produkte angezeigt. Hier bitte auf &amp;quot;'''Anlegen'''&amp;quot; klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteVerkauf3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen dann folgende Ansicht angezeigt und können nun hier, neue Produkte hinzufügen, in Kategorien einteilen, die Produktart wählen und den Verkaufspreis festlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Beispiel'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Die Felder die ausgefüllt werden müssen sind alles '''MUSS''' Felder und '''KEINE''' kann Felder!&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gehen Sie bitte Schritt für Schritt vor.....&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Produktbezeichnung eintragen (im Beispiel Chef Salat).&lt;br /&gt;
#Häkchen bei- Kann verkauft werden '''MUSS''' gesetzt sein. ''(&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;fehlt dieses Häkchen wird das Produkt nicht auf dem POS angezeig&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;t).''&lt;br /&gt;
#Häkchen bei- Kann eingekauft werden '''MUSS''' gesetzt sein.                                                                                                                                       &amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Reiter Allgemeine Informationen &amp;lt;&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
#Produktart '''MUSS''' ausgewählt werden (im Beispiel Dienstleistung).&lt;br /&gt;
#Interne Referenz '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden (im Beispiel 11).&lt;br /&gt;
#Interne Kategorie '''MUSS''' ausgewählt werden (im Beispiel Alle/Speisen).&lt;br /&gt;
#Verkaufspreis '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.[[Datei:image12.png|ohne|mini|627x627px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Reiter Verkauf &amp;lt;&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Häkchen bei- Verfügbar am Point Of Sale '''MUSS''' gesetzt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
#Point of Sale Kategorie '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden. (im Beispiel, Speisen).[[Datei:image14.png|ohne|mini|591x591px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
#&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Im Reiter Abrechnung &amp;lt; (''hier wird auch die MwSt. eingetragen oder angepasst'')&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
##Steuern (Verkauf) '''MUSS''' die Umsatzsteuer eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
##Steuern (Einkauf) '''MUSS''' die Vorsteuer eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
##Fakturierungsregel- '''MUSS''' Rechnung bei Auftrag angeklickt werden.[[Datei:image15.png|ohne|mini|568x568px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Reiter Ticket &amp;lt;&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
###Reihenfolge '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Ticket Display Name '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Print Name '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Lock Timeout (Sec) '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Ticket Template '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.[[Datei:image16.png|ohne|mini|514x514px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende bitte oben links &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot; nicht vergessen.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Wenn Sie bei den Produkten etwas verändert, hinzugefügt oder gelöscht haben müssen Sie bitte das POS nach den Veränderungen NEU STARTEN , da ihre Änderungen sonst nicht an das POS übertragen werden. }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie möchten ein Produkt welches Sie nicht mehr verkaufen ausblenden,...gehen Sie bitte wie folgt vor:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt welches Sie nicht mehr verkaufen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt ausblenden.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie bitte auf das Feld &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt ausblenden1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Dann entfernen Sie bitte den Haken bei &amp;quot;Kann verkauft werden&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt ausblenden2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende oben links bitte &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Ersatz- oder neue Produkte hinzufügen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächste Seite dem &amp;quot;Armaturenbrett&amp;quot; öffnen Sie bitte Ersatzprodukte- Alle&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Ersatzprodukte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun folgende Liste angezeigt &amp;quot;Ersatzproduktgruppe&amp;quot; klicken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Anlegen&amp;quot;:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Ersatzproduktgruppe.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun Ersatzproduktgruppe/NEU angezeigt und können hier jetzt ihre Produkte/Ersatzprodukte anlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ErsatzproduktgruppeNEU.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende oben links bitte &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie möchten in der Ersatzproduktgruppe schon bestehende Gruppen/Produkte ändern, dann gehen Sie wie folgt vor:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie bitte die Gruppe aus welche Sie ändern möchten indem Sie diese direkt anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Ersatzproduktgruppe ändern.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Fenster bitte oben links &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot; anklicken, danach können Sie die Gruppe/Produkte bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Bearbeitung klicken Sie oben links bitte wieder auf  &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_______________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
====Produktzuordnung Damen Provision====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächste Seite dem &amp;quot;Armaturenbrett&amp;quot; öffnen Sie bitte unter &amp;quot;Cashback&amp;quot;  Produkt-Cashback.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Armaturenbrett.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächsten Seite &amp;quot;Produkt-Cahsback&amp;quot; klicken Sie bitte auf das Produkt wo Sie den Cashback angezeigt bekommen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt Cashback2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächsten Seite klicken Sie auf &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;, im Anschluss können Sie die Daten bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt Cashback3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende oben links bitte &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_______________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________ &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/ Karten Historie====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf RFID-Karten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Historie1a.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Registrierte Karten angezeigt. Hier bitte auf &amp;quot; '''Karten-Aktionen'''&amp;quot; und im Anschluss auf &amp;quot;'''Kartenbericht klicken'''&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Historie2a.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich RFID-Kartenbericht erstellen, hier geben Sie bitte eine Karten- oder Spind Nummer ein: und klicken im Anschluss auf Erzeugen Sie:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Historie3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Jetzt bekommen Sie den Bericht angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten HistorieBericht.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Personen anlegen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Partners.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiteranlegenbackend.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Liste Partners angezeigt, hier klicken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;'''Anlegen'''&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiteranlegenbackend1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun Partner/Neu angezeigt und können jetzt hier die jeweilige Person/Personen anlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiteranlegenbackend2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Am Ende Speichern oben links bitte nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt öffnen Sie bitte eine Kassensitzung '''&amp;quot;KARTENAUSGABE'''&amp;quot;.[[Datei:BackendPOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Kasse Kartenausgabe &amp;quot;'''Neue Sitzung'''&amp;quot; (wenn vorher noch keine geöffnet war). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Kasse Kartenausgabe.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 [[Datei:RFID Karte Personal.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Lady Karte.png|ohne|mini|309x309px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Lady anlegen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Elke Brenner anlegen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine neue RFID Karte.[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Anschluss sehen Sie das ausgewählte Produkt, bestätigen Sie bitte mit Zahlung:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Lady Karte Kasse x.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nachdem Sie Zahlung angeklickt haben bitte mit der Supervisor Karte bestätigen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Die Person ist nun im System angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Personen deaktivieren====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Kassensitzung====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf  Point of Sale (POS).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendPOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Kassen angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Je nachdem welche Kasse Sie jetzt öffnen möchten klicken Sie auf der jeweiligen Kasse &amp;quot;'''Neue Sitzung'''&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(Beispiel 1, Kasse).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendPOS2 - Kopie.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich die Kasse.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendPOS3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===MwSt. Satz eintragen, verändern und anzeigen.===&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf Verkauf.[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Öffnen Sie unter Verkauf den Reiter &amp;quot;Konfiguration&amp;quot; und klicken dann bitte auf &amp;quot;Produktkategorien&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:MwSt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie in der Liste die sich geöffnet hat z.B. auf Alle/Säfte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produktkategorien1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun das Produkt Säfte und klicken hier bitte auf  &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Säfte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie nun die MwSt. bearbeiten, anpassen, ändern.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Steuer bearbeiten.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte am Ende des Vorgangs oben links &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot; nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Backend/Ticketnutzung===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Backend/Spindnutzung===&lt;br /&gt;
{{Links | Thema1 = }}&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=KAMBERI_GROUP&amp;diff=5791</id>
		<title>KAMBERI GROUP</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=KAMBERI_GROUP&amp;diff=5791"/>
		<updated>2021-11-10T10:25:23Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: /* ....hier weiter bearbeiten */&lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;&lt;br /&gt;
=='''Bedienungsanleitung'''==&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Eingangsautomat===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Herren Tageskarte¶(Barzahlung)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, Tageskarte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Tageskarte Herren2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Bargeld).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlart Bargeld.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, Barzahlung &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Barzahlung.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Herren Tageskarte ¶(Kartenzahlung)''' &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, Tageskarte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Tageskarte Herren2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Kartenzahlung).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Die einzelnen Schritte wiederholen sich bei allen weiteren Bezahlvorgängen. }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, bezahlen Sie mit ihrer EC oder Kreditkarte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung Karte2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Bezahlung bitte Karte entnehmen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte Karte entnehmen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''10er-Karte Herren ¶(Barzahlung)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, 10er Karte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung 10er Karte Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Bargeld).[[Datei:Bezahlart Bargeld.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, Barzahlung&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Barzahlung 10erKarte Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''10er-Karte Herren¶(Kartenzahlung)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücken Sie Button Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2, treffen Sie ihre Auswahl.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 3, 10er Karte Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Tippen Sie unten rechts auf Bezahlung und wählen im Anschluss ihre Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlung 10er Karte Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Bezahlart wählen und bezahlen (im Beispiel Kartenzahlung).[[Datei:Bezahlung Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 5, Kartenzahlung&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:10er Karte Bezahlung mit Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Bezahlung bitte Karte entnehmen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte Karte entnehmen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Check-In Ablauf 10er Karte Herren'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Automat zeigt ihnen nach dem Scannen der RFID-Karte eine Gesamtübersicht&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
und ihre restlichen Passagen. Drücken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Bezahlung&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Check In Herren 10er Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt &amp;quot;Vorgang Fertiggestellt&amp;quot; und können durch das Gate eintreten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Check IN Herren 10er Karte abgeschlossen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Check-In Ablauf Ladies Karte'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Automat zeigt ihnen nach dem Scannen der RFID-Karte eine Gesamtübersicht,&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
den Gesamtbetrag der zu bezahlen ist, die Produkte und die Gültigkeit der Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Bezahlung&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Check in Ladies2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Und wählen im Anschluss eine Bezahlart aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bezahlart wählen2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Bezahlvorgang können Sie durch das Gate eintreten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Ausgangsautomat===&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:VU Ausgang.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;(''in Bearbeitung'').........&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
__________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Kasse Kartenausgabe===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====POS / RFID - Damen Karte freier Eintritt====&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 1, drücke Sie Button Damen Freier Eintritt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt1.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 2,  bitte Scannen Sie eine RFID Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt2.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt3, drücken Sie den Button Bezahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt3.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Schritt 4, Vorgang abgeschlossen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenFreierEintritt4.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Jeglicher Zutritt nur mit vorherigem Check-In am Automaten möglich!&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
1. Check-In am Automat&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
2. Zutritt durch das Gate&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
3. Nur dann ist der Kauf von Produkten möglich. }}&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====POS / RFID - Karte Herren freier Eintritt====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos1.png|ohne|mini|289x289px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie dann das Produkt  RFID-Karte Herren kostenlos aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos2.png|ohne|mini|290x290px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Feld Kasse wird nun die kostenlose Herren Karte mit 0,00€ angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos4.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie nun auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:HerrenKartekostenlos5.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint die Aufforderung Zahlung: 0,00 € bitte Karte scannen, &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
scannen Sie nun bitte die Master-Karte.[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint das folgende Fenster (der Kunde hat bezahlt).[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Jeglicher Zutritt nur mit vorherigem Check-In am Automaten möglich!&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
1. Check-In am Automat&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
2. Zutritt durch das Gate&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
3. Nur dann ist der Kauf von Produkten möglich. }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
______________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====POS / RFID - Karte Damen====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID Karte Damen aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartekostenlosPOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun ein Suchfeld angezeigt (Kunden suchen).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf die Lupe und es öffnet sich folgendes Fenster (Namensliste).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie aus der Namensliste nun die Dame welcher Sie die Karte zuordnen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Anschluss drücken Sie den Button  &amp;quot;Kunde auswählen &amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint die Aufforderung &amp;quot;Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS7.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Feld Kasse wird nun die kostenlose Damen Karte mit 0,00€ angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS8.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie nun auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS9.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint die Aufforderung Zahlung: 0,00 € bitte Karte scannen, &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es erscheint das folgende Fenster (der Kunde hat bezahlt).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Kasse Bar===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Produktverkauf====&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Ladebildschirm gelangen Sie auf die POS-Schnittstelle.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:POS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um eine Bestellung aufzugeben, wählen Sie zunächst den Produkttyp.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um Produkte aus einer anderen Kategorie auszuwählen, müssen Sie auf das Home-Symbol klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um die Menge eines Produkts zu erhöhen, müssen Sie mehrmals auf das Produkt klicken oder die Menge mit Hilfe der Zahlenleiste ändern.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können auch die Menge eines bereits hinzugefügten Produkts ändern, indem Sie es im Warenkorb markieren und dann den Ziffernblock verwenden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos7.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um ein Produkt aus dem Warenkorb zu entfernen, müssen Sie das Produkt markieren und dann auf dem Ziffernblock zweimal die Löschtaste drücken (bei einmaligem Drücken wird nur die Menge entfernt).&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie die Bestellung vollständig löschen möchten, wiederholen Sie den Vorgang, bis der Warenkorb leer ist.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos8.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Produkte in der Kategorie Champagner haben ein Bonus. Wenn Sie ein solches Produkt hinzufügen, werden Sie aufgefordert, eine Person auszuwählen, auf deren Konto der Bonus gutgeschrieben werden soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um eine Person auszuwählen, klicken Sie auf das Lupensymbol oder geben Sie einen Namen ein.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie dann aus der Liste die Person aus die den Bonus erhalten soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos11.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Danach klicken Sie bitte die Schaltfläche &amp;quot;Hinzufügen&amp;quot;. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn keine Notwendigkeit besteht, einen Bonus hinzuzufügen, überspringen Sie diesen Schritt, indem Sie auf die Schaltfläche &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;quot;Weiter &amp;quot; klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos13.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nachdem Sie eine Bestellung aufgegeben haben, müssen Sie diese bestätigen. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Um Ihre Bestellung zu bestätigen, klicken Sie auf die Schaltfläche &amp;quot;Zahlung&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos14.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Scannen Sie dann bitte eine Kundenkarte. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos15.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn die Bestellung erfolgreich erstellt wurde, sehen Sie folgendes im Informationsfenster, das sich öffnet.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:pos16.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Durchführung Storno====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie haben ihre Kasse geöffnet und möchten ein Storno durchführen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Kunde im Beispiel hat einen Apfelsaft gekauft.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie bitte auf Storno.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich folgende Ansicht, hier drücken Sie bitte auf die Lupe.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun alle Produkte von diesem Tag angezeigt die Sie stornieren können.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie bitte auf Storno.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der nächsten Ansicht bekommen Sie das Produkt angezeigt was storniert werden soll. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Drücken Sie bitte auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno7.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt bitte Karte scannen. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Scannen Sie bitte die Karte auf der das Produkt storniert werden soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno8.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun folgendes zuerst angezeigt...&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
....und gleich im Anschluss&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Scannen Sie nun bitte die Supervisor-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Vorgang ist danach abgeschlossen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können dies wie folgt prüfen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 1&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie bitte auf Storno.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Und in der nächsten Ansicht wieder auf die Lupe.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun das hinter dem Produkt was Sie gerade storniert haben kein &amp;quot;STORNO&amp;quot; mehr steht.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno12.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 2&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf der Kasse auf RFID Info.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno13.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie die RFID Karte wo der Betrag wieder gutgeschrieben werden sollte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno14.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter Kartenguthaben sehen Sie den Betrag auf der Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno15.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 3 (im Backend)&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen im Backend bei Bestellungen das die 3,50€ wieder Gutgeschrieben wurden.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno16.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Prüfung 4&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der gleichen Ansicht können Sie auf den Minus Betrag drücken und bekommen dann&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
in der nächsten Ansicht unter Typ die Verkaufsrückerstattung angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Durchführung Storno17.png|ohne|mini]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Bestellung mit Spindnummer (Angemeldet ist ein Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie ein Produkt aus (z.B. Softgetränke).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt z.B. Coca Cola&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich folgendes PopUp.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie klicken bitte auf Spinde.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun ein Zahleneingabefeld&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Hier geben Sie die Spindnummer vom Kunden ein,&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image6.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
danach erscheint &amp;quot;Bitte scannen Sie die Supervisor Karte&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem scannen der Supervisor Karte, sehen Sie das gewählte Produkt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie drücken bitte auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt das der Kunde bezahlt hat.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Bestellung mit Spindnummer (Angemeldet ist ein Supervisor/Manager)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie ein Produkt aus (z.B. Softgetränke).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt z.B. Coca Cola&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich folgendes PopUp.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie klicken bitte auf Spinde.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun ein Zahleneingabefeld&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Hier geben Sie die Spindnummer vom Kunden ein&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen das gewählte Produkt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie drücken bitte auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image9.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun angezeigt das der Kunde bezahlt hat.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image10.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&amp;lt;span name=&amp;quot;Sobald-Sie-die-Zahlungsmethode-gewählt-haben-entnehmen-Sie-bitte-nach-dem-Bezahlvorgang-Ihre-Kredit--oder-Girokarte-Ihr-Wechselgeld-und-Ihre-Quittung-je-nach-Zahlungsmethode&amp;quot;&amp;gt;&amp;lt;/span&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Mitarbeiter===&lt;br /&gt;
Mitarbeiter können ebenfalls an der Kasse Kartenausgabe verwaltet werden.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====RFID Personalkarte (Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin ist schon in der Namensliste hinterlegt)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Herren Karte 1.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID Personalkarte aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Personalkarte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun ein Suchfeld angezeigt (Kunden suchen).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ist der Mitarbeiter/die Mitarbeiterin  schon registriert drücken Sie auf die Lupe, &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
es öffnet sich folgendes Fenster: (Namensliste).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:DamenKartePOS4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Aus der Namensliste wählen Sie nun den Mitarbeiter/die Mitarbeiterin aus welche die Karte erhalten soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Kunde auswählen.png|mini|ohne]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine neue RFID-Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem scannen der Karte sehen Sie auf der Kassenansicht das gewählte Produkt&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(inkl. der Inhalte), drücken Sie nun auf Zahlung.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Personalkarte bezahlen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Der Kunde hat bezahlt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
___________________________________________________________________________________________                &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====RFID Personalkarte (Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin ist noch nicht erfasst)====&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Herren Karte 1.jpg|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt RFID Personalkarte aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Personalkarte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun folgende Ansicht: (bitte auf die Abb. Figur mit dem + Zeichen klicken).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun folgende Ansicht: (legen Sie hier nun den Mitarbeiter/Mitarbeiterin an).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nachdem Sie alle erforderlichen Felder ausgefüllt haben klicken Sie bitte auf  Speichern.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie nun auf Kunde Auswählen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiter anlegen4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Wiederholen Sie bitte ab hier die Schritte aus der Anleitung. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Die einzelnen Schritte wiederholen sich bei allen weiteren RFID- Personalkarten ( Personalleiter, Supervisor und Lady-Karte) }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Registrierung Damen===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Registrierungsablauf====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie '''Registrieren''' aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Registrieren auf dem Tablet.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Erfassen Sie die notwendigen Daten, am Ende bestätigen Sie bitte mit WEITER.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte auswählen:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ich nehme am Düsseldorfer Verfahren teil und beauftrage den Betreiber die Tagespauschale an das Finanzamt abzuführen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
oder&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ich nehme nicht am Düsseldorfer Verfahren teil.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bestätigung der AGB und Datenschutzhinweise nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Registrieren auf dem Tablet2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Management Spinde===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Spinde nach Kontrolle und Reinigung durch Fachpersonal====&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Beispiel:''' &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
18 Spinde sind nach Nutzung durch den Kunden noch nicht wieder freigegeben.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
3 Spinde sind schon wieder (grün) und freigegeben.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:spinde1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie nach der Reinigung und Kontrolle einfach mit der linken Maustaste einmal auf die Spind Nummer die wieder &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
freigegeben werden soll.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:spinde2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Spind 4 und 5 nach Freigabe durch Fachpersonal.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:spinde3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Backendverwaltung===&lt;br /&gt;
Im Backend können nur Aufgaben entsprechend der vergebenen Berechtigungsstruktur erfolgen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Auswertung Kartennutzungen====&lt;br /&gt;
'''1. Anmeldung im Backend'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Melden Sie sich mit Ihren Zugangsdaten die Sie erhalten haben im Backend an:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:AnmeldungBackend.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Anmeldung öffnet sich folgendes Fenster: Sie klicken bitte die kleine Kachel oben links an.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:AnmeldungBackend1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun folgendes Bild angezeigt: (Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendnachAnmeldung.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''2. Produktauswertung einer Karte (am Beispiel Herren)'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteVerkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. Hier unter Verkauf die Liste öffnen und dann Produkte anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteVerkauf2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produkte angezeigt, hier geben Sie im Suchfeld z.B. &amp;quot;Herren&amp;quot; ein.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteKarteBeispielHerren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun in dieser Ansicht alle Produkte angezeigt die das Wort &amp;quot;Herren&amp;quot; enthalten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie im Beispielfall das Produkt Herren 50,00 € aus.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produkte/Herren angezeigt, hier klicken Sie bitte auf Ticket.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der nächsten Ansicht klicken Sie bitte auf Card Gentlemen Template.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der Ansicht Produkte/Herren/Card Gentlemen Template klicken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Additional Products&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 4.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun eine Liste aller Produkte auf der Herren Karte angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Herren50€ 5.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''3. Gültigkeit einer Karte'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gültigkeit einer Damen oder Herren Karte. Klicken Sie auf Tickets&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:GültigkeitTicket1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun folgende Ansicht &amp;quot;Tickets&amp;quot;- in der Liste sehen Sie das Produkt Ladies.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Eine Gültigkeitsdauer, unter von-Zu wird nicht angezeigt, weil eine Ladies Karte nach dem Eintritt ihre Gültigkeit bis zum Austritt behält.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:GültigkeitTicket2Damen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gültigkeit einer Herren Karte. Klicken Sie wie Abb. oben auf Tickets, Sie bekommen dann die gleiche Liste angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Eine Herren Karte ist immer 24 Stunden gültig oder bis zum Austritt des Herren.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:GültigkeitTicket2Herren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''4. Spind Nummer einer Karte'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Spinde.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:SpindeBackend.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Spinde angezeigt:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen in der Ansicht die Spind Nummern, den Zustand, die Größe, die Kartennummer und gereinigt am, so wie aktiviert oder nicht aktiviert angezeigt. Über die einzelnen Überschriften können Sie auch sortieren.[[Datei:AnsichtSpinde.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''5. Karte deaktivieren'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf RFID-Karten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Lady Karte deaktivieren.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen jetzt alle registrierten Karten angezeigt, wählen Sie hier die Karte aus die deaktiviert werden soll. &lt;br /&gt;
Sie können hierzu die Karten Nummer, die EAN Nr., Type, Partner oder Ausgabedatum anklicken.  &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren1.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Nun sehen Sie den aufgerufenen Datensatz, klicken Sie hier bitte '''&amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;'''. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren2.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt klicken Sie bitte auf '''&amp;quot;Verfallsdatum Deaktiviert&amp;quot;'''., und im Anschluss auf &amp;quot;'''Speichern'''&amp;quot;. &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren2a.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Jetzt ist die Karte deaktiviert, Sie können dies mit einem Schritt zurück überprüfen. &lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hierzu bitte auf &amp;quot;'''Registrierte Karten'''&amp;quot;.  &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren4.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun bei dem Datensatz welchen Sie zuvor gewählt hatten in der Spalte &amp;quot;Deaktiviert&amp;quot; einen Haken.  &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karte deaktivieren5.png|ohne|mini]] &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''6. Bei Verlust einer Karte (Kartendaten übertragen auf die die neue Karte)'''         &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend PoS-Produktkategorien anlegen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Kasse.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image17.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Kasse angezeigt. Hier bitte unter Konfiguration, '''PoS-Produktkategorien''' wählen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht PoS-Produktkategorien angezeigt. Hier bitte oben links '''&amp;quot;Anlegen&amp;quot;''' wählen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image19.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Fenster was sich öffnet tragen Sie den Namen der Produktkategorie und eine Nummer für die Reihenfolge ein.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#(im Beispiel Zigaretten).&lt;br /&gt;
#Nummer/Reihenfolge.&lt;br /&gt;
#Speichern&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image20.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Speichern wählen Sie bitte wieder '''PoS-Produktkategorien.'''&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image21.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun in der Liste PoS-Produktkategorien das neue Produkt Zigaretten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image22.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Wenn Sie bei den Produkten etwas verändert, hinzugefügt oder gelöscht haben müssen Sie bitte das POS nach den Veränderungen NEU STARTEN , da ihre Änderungen sonst nicht an das POS übertragen werden. }}_______________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend PoS-Produktkategorien löschen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Kasse.[[Datei:image17.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Kasse angezeigt. Hier bitte unter Konfiguration, '''PoS-Produktkategorien''' wählen.[[Datei:image18.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht PoS-Produktkategorien angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier wählen Sie wieder das Beispiel Zigaretten.[[Datei:image22.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun das angelegte Produkt angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier wählen Sie Aktion und dann &amp;quot;Löschen&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image23.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen dann nochmal einen Hinweis angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Ob Sie den Datensatz wirklich löschen möchten?&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie mit OK bestätigen ist der Datensatz gelöscht.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image24.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Überprüfung ob der Datensatz wirklich gelöscht wurde.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie wählen erneut '''PoS-Produktkategorien.'''&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image25.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''In der Liste die Sie jetzt angezeigt bekommen sollte das gelöschte Produkt (im Beispiel Zigaretten)''' &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''nicht mehr angezeigt werden.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Produktkategorien anlegen'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier unter Konfiguration die Liste öffnen und dann '''Produktkategorien''' anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image26.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produktkategorien angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier wählen Sie oben links &amp;quot;Anlegen&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image27.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie können nun eine neue Produktkategorie anlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(im Beispiel Kondome)&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hierzu gehen Sie wie folgt vor:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
# Sie tragen den Kategoriennamen ein.&lt;br /&gt;
# Bei Oberkategorie wählen Sie ALLE aus.&lt;br /&gt;
# Speichern nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
# Alles andere ist vor eingestellt und muss nicht verändert werden wenn es dazu keinen Anlass gibt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image29.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach dem Speichern prüfen Sie bitte selbst ob ihre neue Produktkategorie angelegt wurde.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Dazu wählen Sie einfach nach dem Speichern '''Produktkatgorien'''.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image30.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun am Ende der Liste ihre neu angelegte Produktkategorie.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image31.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
__________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Produktkategorien ändern oder löschen'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier unter Konfiguration die Liste öffnen und dann '''Produktkategorien''' anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image26.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produktkategorien angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie wählen einfach die Produktkategorie aus die Sie ändern oder löschen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(im Beispiel Kondome)&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image31.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun das Bearbeitungsfenster angezeigt (wie schon beim anlegen einer neuen Produktkategorie).&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie oben links 1. wählen können Sie die Produktkategorie bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Die Schritte danach sind die gleichen wie beim anlegen einer neuen Produktkategorie&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Unter 2. Aktion können Sie die Produktkategorie löschen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image32.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wenn Sie löschen gewählt haben werden Sie nochmal gefragt ob Sie den Datensatz wirklich löschen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image33.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Auswahl '''OK''' können Sie wieder selbst prüfen ob die Produktkategorie gelöscht wurde.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie wählen dazu einfach oben links wieder Produktkategorien und gelangen so zur Liste.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
In der Liste sollte der Eintrag Kondome nun fehlen und wurde somit erfolgreich gelöscht.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image34.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
___________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Produkte anlegen/ hinzufügen und ausblenden, MwSt. Satz eintragen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Verkauf angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier unter Verkauf die Liste öffnen und dann '''Produkte''' anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:image11.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Ansicht Produkte angezeigt. Hier bitte auf &amp;quot;'''Anlegen'''&amp;quot; klicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ProdukteVerkauf3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen dann folgende Ansicht angezeigt und können nun hier, neue Produkte hinzufügen, in Kategorien einteilen, die Produktart wählen und den Verkaufspreis festlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Beispiel'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Die Felder die ausgefüllt werden müssen sind alles '''MUSS''' Felder und '''KEINE''' kann Felder!&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Gehen Sie bitte Schritt für Schritt vor.....&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Produktbezeichnung eintragen (im Beispiel Chef Salat).&lt;br /&gt;
#Häkchen bei- Kann verkauft werden '''MUSS''' gesetzt sein. ''(&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;fehlt dieses Häkchen wird das Produkt nicht auf dem POS angezeig&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;t).''&lt;br /&gt;
#Häkchen bei- Kann eingekauft werden '''MUSS''' gesetzt sein.                                                                                                                                       &amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Reiter Allgemeine Informationen &amp;lt;&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
#Produktart '''MUSS''' ausgewählt werden (im Beispiel Dienstleistung).&lt;br /&gt;
#Interne Referenz '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden (im Beispiel 11).&lt;br /&gt;
#Interne Kategorie '''MUSS''' ausgewählt werden (im Beispiel Alle/Speisen).&lt;br /&gt;
#Verkaufspreis '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.[[Datei:image12.png|ohne|mini|627x627px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Reiter Verkauf &amp;lt;&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
#Häkchen bei- Verfügbar am Point Of Sale '''MUSS''' gesetzt werden.&lt;br /&gt;
#Point of Sale Kategorie '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden. (im Beispiel, Speisen).[[Datei:image14.png|ohne|mini|591x591px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
#&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Im Reiter Abrechnung &amp;lt; (''hier wird auch die MwSt. eingetragen oder angepasst'')&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
##Steuern (Verkauf) '''MUSS''' die Umsatzsteuer eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
##Steuern (Einkauf) '''MUSS''' die Vorsteuer eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
##Fakturierungsregel- '''MUSS''' Rechnung bei Auftrag angeklickt werden.[[Datei:image15.png|ohne|mini|568x568px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&amp;lt;u&amp;gt;&amp;gt; Reiter Ticket &amp;lt;&amp;lt;/u&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
###Reihenfolge '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Ticket Display Name '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Print Name '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Lock Timeout (Sec) '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.&lt;br /&gt;
###Ticket Template '''MUSS''' eingetragen werden.[[Datei:image16.png|ohne|mini|514x514px]]&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende bitte oben links &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot; nicht vergessen.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
{{Box_Hinweis|Hinweis Text = Wenn Sie bei den Produkten etwas verändert, hinzugefügt oder gelöscht haben müssen Sie bitte das POS nach den Veränderungen NEU STARTEN , da ihre Änderungen sonst nicht an das POS übertragen werden. }}&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;nowiki&amp;gt;-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------&amp;lt;/nowiki&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie möchten ein Produkt welches Sie nicht mehr verkaufen ausblenden,...gehen Sie bitte wie folgt vor:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie das Produkt welches Sie nicht mehr verkaufen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt ausblenden.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie bitte auf das Feld &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt ausblenden1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Dann entfernen Sie bitte den Haken bei &amp;quot;Kann verkauft werden&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt ausblenden2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende oben links bitte &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Ersatz- oder neue Produkte hinzufügen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächste Seite dem &amp;quot;Armaturenbrett&amp;quot; öffnen Sie bitte Ersatzprodukte- Alle&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Ersatzprodukte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun folgende Liste angezeigt &amp;quot;Ersatzproduktgruppe&amp;quot; klicken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;Anlegen&amp;quot;:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Ersatzproduktgruppe.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun Ersatzproduktgruppe/NEU angezeigt und können hier jetzt ihre Produkte/Ersatzprodukte anlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:ErsatzproduktgruppeNEU.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende oben links bitte &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie möchten in der Ersatzproduktgruppe schon bestehende Gruppen/Produkte ändern, dann gehen Sie wie folgt vor:&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Wählen Sie bitte die Gruppe aus welche Sie ändern möchten indem Sie diese direkt anklicken.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Ersatzproduktgruppe ändern.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Fenster bitte oben links &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot; anklicken, danach können Sie die Gruppe/Produkte bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nach der Bearbeitung klicken Sie oben links bitte wieder auf  &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_______________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
====Produktzuordnung Damen Provision====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Verkauf.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächste Seite dem &amp;quot;Armaturenbrett&amp;quot; öffnen Sie bitte unter &amp;quot;Cashback&amp;quot;  Produkt-Cashback.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Armaturenbrett.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächsten Seite &amp;quot;Produkt-Cahsback&amp;quot; klicken Sie bitte auf das Produkt wo Sie den Cashback angezeigt bekommen möchten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt Cashback2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Auf der nächsten Seite klicken Sie auf &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;, im Anschluss können Sie die Daten bearbeiten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produkt Cashback3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
'''Am Ende oben links bitte &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot;.'''&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_______________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________ &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/ Karten Historie====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf RFID-Karten.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Historie1a.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Registrierte Karten angezeigt. Hier bitte auf &amp;quot; '''Karten-Aktionen'''&amp;quot; und im Anschluss auf &amp;quot;'''Kartenbericht klicken'''&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Historie2a.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich RFID-Kartenbericht erstellen, hier geben Sie bitte eine Karten- oder Spind Nummer ein: und klicken im Anschluss auf Erzeugen Sie:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten Historie3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Jetzt bekommen Sie den Bericht angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Karten HistorieBericht.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Personen anlegen====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf Partners.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiteranlegenbackend.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Liste Partners angezeigt, hier klicken Sie bitte auf &amp;quot;'''Anlegen'''&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiteranlegenbackend1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun Partner/Neu angezeigt und können jetzt hier die jeweilige Person/Personen anlegen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Mitarbeiteranlegenbackend2.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Am Ende Speichern oben links bitte nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im nächsten Schritt öffnen Sie bitte eine Kassensitzung '''&amp;quot;KARTENAUSGABE'''&amp;quot;.[[Datei:BackendPOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 &lt;br /&gt;
Kasse Kartenausgabe &amp;quot;'''Neue Sitzung'''&amp;quot; (wenn vorher noch keine geöffnet war). &lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Kasse Kartenausgabe.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
 [[Datei:RFID Karte Personal.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:RFID Lady Karte.png|ohne|mini|309x309px]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Lady anlegen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Elke Brenner anlegen.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte scannen Sie eine neue RFID Karte.[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie eine RFID-Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Im Anschluss sehen Sie das ausgewählte Produkt, bestätigen Sie bitte mit Zahlung:&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Lady Karte Kasse x.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Nachdem Sie Zahlung angeklickt haben bitte mit der Supervisor Karte bestätigen.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Bitte scannen Sie die Manager Karte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Die Person ist nun im System angelegt.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Der Kunde hat bezahlt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
_________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Personen deaktivieren====&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
====Backend/Kassensitzung====&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nach der Anmeldung das Bild mit der Auswahl der einzelnen Funktionen angezeigt.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie hier auf  Point of Sale (POS).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendPOS1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie bekommen nun die Kassen angezeigt. &lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Je nachdem welche Kasse Sie jetzt öffnen möchten klicken Sie auf der jeweiligen Kasse &amp;quot;'''Neue Sitzung'''&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
(Beispiel 1, Kasse).&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendPOS2 - Kopie.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Es öffnet sich die Kasse.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:BackendPOS3.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
===MwSt. Satz eintragen, verändern und anzeigen.===&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie auf Verkauf.[[Datei:Verkauf.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Öffnen Sie unter Verkauf den Reiter &amp;quot;Konfiguration&amp;quot; und klicken dann bitte auf &amp;quot;Produktkategorien&amp;quot;.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:MwSt.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Klicken Sie in der Liste die sich geöffnet hat z.B. auf Alle/Säfte&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Produktkategorien1.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Sie sehen nun das Produkt Säfte und klicken hier bitte auf  &amp;quot;Bearbeiten&amp;quot;&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Säfte.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
Hier können Sie nun die MwSt. bearbeiten, anpassen, ändern.&lt;br /&gt;
[[Datei:Steuer bearbeiten.png|ohne|mini]]&lt;br /&gt;
Bitte am Ende des Vorgangs oben links &amp;quot;Speichern&amp;quot; nicht vergessen.&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&amp;lt;br /&amp;gt;&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Backend/Ticketnutzung===&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
____________________________________________________________________________________________________________________&lt;br /&gt;
&lt;br /&gt;
===Backend/Spindnutzung===&lt;br /&gt;
{{Links | Thema1 = }}&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Datei:image34.png&amp;diff=5790</id>
		<title>Datei:image34.png</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Datei:image34.png&amp;diff=5790"/>
		<updated>2021-11-10T10:23:41Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;image34&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Datei:image33.png&amp;diff=5789</id>
		<title>Datei:image33.png</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Datei:image33.png&amp;diff=5789"/>
		<updated>2021-11-10T10:19:56Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;image33&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Datei:image32.png&amp;diff=5788</id>
		<title>Datei:image32.png</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Datei:image32.png&amp;diff=5788"/>
		<updated>2021-11-10T10:15:41Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;image32&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
	<entry>
		<id>https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Datei:image31.png&amp;diff=5787</id>
		<title>Datei:image31.png</title>
		<link rel="alternate" type="text/html" href="https://docs.maxcrc.de/w/index.php?title=Datei:image31.png&amp;diff=5787"/>
		<updated>2021-11-10T10:05:01Z</updated>

		<summary type="html">&lt;p&gt;Mschindler: &lt;/p&gt;
&lt;hr /&gt;
&lt;div&gt;image31&lt;/div&gt;</summary>
		<author><name>Mschindler</name></author>
		
	</entry>
</feed>